blob: 2cbf90dcf11cbddbfb2e5776116d1b81d00384ef [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue59fcdd2016-11-25 16:39:17 +01007 2016/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004702.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
539 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200540 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100541 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200542 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200544 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100546 - presetenv
547 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 - uid
549 - ulimit-n
550 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100551 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200552 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200553 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
554 - ssl-default-bind-options
555 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-server-options
557 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100558 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100559 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100560 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100561 - 51degrees-data-file
562 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200563 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200564 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100565 - wurfl-data-file
566 - wurfl-information-list
567 - wurfl-information-list-separator
568 - wurfl-engine-mode
569 - wurfl-cache-size
570 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200573 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200575 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100576 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100577 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100578 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200579 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200580 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200581 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200582 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200583 - noepoll
584 - nokqueue
585 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100586 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300587 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000588 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200589 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200590 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200591 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - tune.buffers.limit
593 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200594 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200595 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100596 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100597 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200598 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100599 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100600 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100601 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100602 - tune.lua.session-timeout
603 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200604 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100605 - tune.maxaccept
606 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200607 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200608 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200609 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100610 - tune.rcvbuf.client
611 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100612 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100613 - tune.sndbuf.client
614 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100615 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100616 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200617 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100618 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200619 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200620 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200621 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100622 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200623 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
624 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
625 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100626 - tune.zlib.memlevel
627 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629 * Debugging
630 - debug
631 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200632
633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006343.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635------------------------------------
636
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200637ca-base <dir>
638 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200639 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
640 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642chroot <jail dir>
643 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
644 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
645 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
646 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
647 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
648 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100649
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100650cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
651 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
652 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
653 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100654 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
655 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
656 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
657 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
658 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
659 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
660 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
661 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
662 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
663 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100664
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200665crt-base <dir>
666 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
667 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
668 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670daemon
671 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
672 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
673 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
674
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200675deviceatlas-json-file <path>
676 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
677 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
678
679deviceatlas-log-level <value>
680 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
681 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
682
683deviceatlas-separator <char>
684 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
685 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
686
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100687deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200688 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
689 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
690 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100691
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900692external-check
693 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
694 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
695 See "option external-check".
696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697gid <number>
698 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
699 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
700 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100701 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
702 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705group <group name>
706 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
707 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100708
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200709log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
711 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100712 configured with "log global".
713
714 <address> can be one of:
715
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100716 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100717 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
718 port).
719
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100720 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
721 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
722 port).
723
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100724 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
725 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
726 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
727 writeable).
728
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
730 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100731
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200732 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
733 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
734 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
735 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
736 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
737 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
738 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
739 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
740 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
741 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
742 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
743
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200744 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
745 one of the following :
746
747 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
748 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
749
750 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
751 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
752
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100753 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200754
755 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
756 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
757 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
758
759 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200760 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
761 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
762 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
763 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
764 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
765 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200767 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100769log-send-hostname [<string>]
770 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
771 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
772 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
773 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
774 the logs.
775
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000776log-tag <string>
777 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
778 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
779 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100780 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000781
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100782lua-load <file>
783 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
784 used multiple times.
785
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200786nbproc <number>
787 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
788 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
789 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
790 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
791 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
792
793pidfile <pidfile>
794 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
795 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
796 starting the process. See also "daemon".
797
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100798presetenv <name> <value>
799 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
800 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
801 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
802 and "unsetenv".
803
804resetenv [<name> ...]
805 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
806 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
807 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
808 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
809 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
810 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
811 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
812 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
813
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100814stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200815 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
816 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
817 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
818 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
819 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
820 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100821 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200822 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
823 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200824
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200825server-state-base <directory>
826 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200827 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
828 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200829
830server-state-file <file>
831 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
832 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
833 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
834 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
835 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
836 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
837 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
838 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200839 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
840 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200841
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100842setenv <name> <value>
843 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
844 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
845 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
846 and "unsetenv".
847
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100848ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
850 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300851 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100852 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
853 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
854 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
855 "bind" keyword for more information.
856
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100857ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
859 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
860 keyword to see available options.
861
862 Example:
863 global
864 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
865
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100866ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
868 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300869 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100870 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
871 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
872 information.
873
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100874ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
876 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
877 keyword to see available options.
878
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200879ssl-dh-param-file <file>
880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
881 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
882 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
883 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
884 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200885 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
886 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
887 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
888 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200889 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
890 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
891 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
892
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100893ssl-server-verify [none|required]
894 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
895 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
896 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
897
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200898stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
899 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
900 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
901 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200902 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
903 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200904
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200905 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
906 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
907 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200908
909stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
910 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
911 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100912 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200913
914stats maxconn <connections>
915 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
916 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
917
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918uid <number>
919 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
920 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
921 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
922 one. See also "gid" and "user".
923
924ulimit-n <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
926 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
927 option.
928
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100929unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
930 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
931
932 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
933 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
934 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
935 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
936 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
937 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
938 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
939 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
940 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
941 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
942
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100943unsetenv [<name> ...]
944 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
945 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
946 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
947 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
948 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
949 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
950 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952user <user name>
953 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
954 See also "uid" and "group".
955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200956node <name>
957 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
958
959 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
960 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
961 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
962 traffic.
963
964description <text>
965 Add a text that describes the instance.
966
967 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
968 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
969 "<" and ">" characters.
970
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010097151degrees-data-file <file path>
972 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
973 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
974
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200975 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100976 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
977
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000097851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100979 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
980 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
981 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
982
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200983 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100984 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
985
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020098651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100987 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
988 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
989
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200990 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
991 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
992
99351degrees-cache-size <number>
994 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
995 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
996 By default, this cache is disabled.
997
998 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100999 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1000
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001001wurfl-data-file <file path>
1002 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1003 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1004
1005 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1006 with USE_WURFL=1.
1007
1008wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1009 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1010 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1011 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1012
1013 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1014
1015 Valid WURFL properties are:
1016 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1017
1018 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1019 device.
1020
1021 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1022 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1023
1024 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1025 particular web request.
1026
1027 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1028 used Libwurfl API version.
1029
1030 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1031 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1032 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1033
1034 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1035 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1036
1037 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1038 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1039
1040 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1041
1042 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1043
1044 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1045 with USE_WURFL=1.
1046
1047wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1048 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1049 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1050
1051 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1052 with USE_WURFL=1.
1053
1054wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1055 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1056 thus before the chroot.
1057
1058 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1059 with USE_WURFL=1.
1060
1061wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1062 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1063 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1064 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1065 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1066 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1067 mode is enabled by default.
1068
1069 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1070 with USE_WURFL=1.
1071
1072wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1073 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1074 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1075 - "0" : no cache is used.
1076 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1077 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1078 the highest performing option.
1079
1080 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1081 with USE_WURFL=1.
1082
1083wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1084 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1085 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1086
1087 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1088 with USE_WURFL=1.
1089
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010913.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001092-----------------------
1093
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001094max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1095 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1096 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1097 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1098 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1099 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1100 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1101 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1102 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104maxconn <number>
1105 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1106 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1107 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001108 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1109 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1110 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1111 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001112 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1113 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1114 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1115 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1116 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001117
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001118maxconnrate <number>
1119 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1120 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1121 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1122 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1123 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1124 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1125 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1126 fairness.
1127
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001128maxcomprate <number>
1129 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001130 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001131 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1132 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1133 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1134 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1135 default value.
1136
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001137maxcompcpuusage <number>
1138 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1139 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1140 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1141 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1142 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1143 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1144 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1145 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1146
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001147maxpipes <number>
1148 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1149 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1150 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1151 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1152 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1153 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1154
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001155maxsessrate <number>
1156 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1157 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1158 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1159 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1160 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1161 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1162 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1163 fairness.
1164
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001165maxsslconn <number>
1166 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1167 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1168 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1169 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1170 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1171 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1172 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001173 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1174 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1175 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1176 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1177 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1178 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1179 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001180
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001181maxsslrate <number>
1182 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1183 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1184 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1185 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1186 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1187 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1188 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1189 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1190 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1191 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1192
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001193maxzlibmem <number>
1194 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1195 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1196 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001197 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1198 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1199 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1200
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001201noepoll
1202 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1203 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001204 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001205
1206nokqueue
1207 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1208 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1209 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1210
1211nopoll
1212 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1213 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001214 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001215 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001216
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001217nosplice
1218 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1219 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1220 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001221 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001222 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1223 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1224 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1225 "option splice-response".
1226
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001227nogetaddrinfo
1228 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1229 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1230
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001231noreuseport
1232 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1233 command line argument "-dR".
1234
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001235spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001236 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1237 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1238 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1239 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1240 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1241 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001242
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001243tune.buffers.limit <number>
1244 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1245 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1246 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1247 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1248 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1249 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1250 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1251 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1252 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1253 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1254 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1255 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1256 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1257 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1258 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1259
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001260tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1261 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1262 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1263 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1264 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1265
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001266tune.bufsize <number>
1267 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1268 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1269 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1270 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1271 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1272 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1273 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1274 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001275 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1276 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1277 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001278
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001279tune.chksize <number>
1280 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1281 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1282 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1283 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1284 checks whenever possible.
1285
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001286tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1287 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1288 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1289 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1290 this value. The default value is 1.
1291
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001292tune.http.cookielen <number>
1293 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1294 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1295 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1296 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1297 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1298 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1299 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1300 to change this value.
1301
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001302tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1303 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1304 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1305 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1306 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1307 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1308 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1309 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1310 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1311 limit too high.
1312
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001313tune.idletimer <timeout>
1314 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1315 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1316 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1317 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1318 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1319 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1320 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1321 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1322 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1323
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001324tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1325 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001326 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001327 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1328 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1329 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1330 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1331 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1332
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001333tune.lua.maxmem
1334 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1335 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1336 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1337 memory.
1338
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001339tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1340 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001341 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1342 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1343 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001344
1345tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1346 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1347 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1348 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1349 check servers.
1350
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001351tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1352 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1353 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1354 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1355 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1356
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001357tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001358 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1359 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1360 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1361 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1362 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1363 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1364 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1365 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1366 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1367 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001368
1369tune.maxpollevents <number>
1370 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1371 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1372 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1373 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1374 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1375
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001376tune.maxrewrite <number>
1377 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1378 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1379 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1380 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1381 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1382 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1383 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1384 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1385 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1386 bufsize.
1387
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001388tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1389 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1390 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1391 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1392 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1393 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1394 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1395 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1396 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1397 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1398 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1399 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1400 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1401 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1402 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1403 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1404 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1405 setting this parameter to 0.
1406
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001407tune.pipesize <number>
1408 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1409 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1410 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1411 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1412 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1413 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1414
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001415tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1416tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1417 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1418 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1419 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1420 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1421 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1422 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1423 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1424
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001425tune.recv_enough <number>
1426 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1427 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1428 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1429 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1430 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1431
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001432tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1433tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1434 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1435 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1436 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1437 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1438 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1439 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1440 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1441 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1442 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1443 notifying haproxy again.
1444
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001445tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001446 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1447 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1448 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001449 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001450 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1451 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1452 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1453 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1454 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001455 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1456 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001457
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001458tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1459 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1460 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1461 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1462 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1463 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1464 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1465
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001466tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1467 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001468 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001469 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1470 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1471 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1472 being used for too long.
1473
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001474tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1475 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1476 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1477 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1478 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1479 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1480 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1481 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1482 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1483 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1484 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001485 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1486 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001487
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001488tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1489 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1490 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1491 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1492 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1493 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1494 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1495 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001496 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1497 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001498
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001499tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1500 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1501 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1502 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1503 1000 entries.
1504
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001505tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001506tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001507tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1508tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1509tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001510 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1511 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1512 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1513 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1514 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1515 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1516 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1517 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001518
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001519 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1520 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1521 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1522 all available space is consumed.
1523 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1524 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1525 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001526
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001527tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1528 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001529 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001530 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1531 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1532 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1533
1534tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1535 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1536 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1537 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1538 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015403.3. Debugging
1541--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001542
1543debug
1544 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1545 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1546 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1547 system startup.
1548
1549quiet
1550 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1551 line argument "-q".
1552
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015543.4. Userlists
1555--------------
1556It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1557http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1558it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1559
1560userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001561 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001562 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1563
1564group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001565 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001566 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1567 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1568
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001569user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1570 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001571 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1572 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001573 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1574 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001575 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001576 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001577
1578
1579 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001580 userlist L1
1581 group G1 users tiger,scott
1582 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001583
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001584 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1585 user scott insecure-password elgato
1586 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001587
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001588 userlist L2
1589 group G1
1590 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001591
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001592 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1593 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1594 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001595
1596 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001597
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001598
15993.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001600----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001601It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1602several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1603instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1604values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1605automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1606In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1607using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1608tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1609reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1610Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1611that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1612each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001613
1614peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001615 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001616 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1617
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001618disabled
1619 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1620 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1621 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1622
1623enable
1624 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1625
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001626peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1627 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1628 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1629 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1630 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1631 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1632 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1633
1634 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1635 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1636
1637 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1638 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1639 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1640 across all peers.
1641
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001642 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1643 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001644
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001645 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001646 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001647 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1648 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1649 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001650
1651 backend mybackend
1652 mode tcp
1653 balance roundrobin
1654 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1655 stick on src
1656
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001657 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1658 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001659
1660
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016613.6. Mailers
1662------------
1663It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1664If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1665in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1666
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001667mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001668 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1669 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1670
1671mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1672 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1673
1674 Example:
1675 mailers mymailers
1676 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1677 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1678
1679 backend mybackend
1680 mode tcp
1681 balance roundrobin
1682
1683 email-alert mailers mymailers
1684 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1685 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1686
1687 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1688 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1689
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001690timeout mail <time>
1691 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1692 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1693 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1694 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1695
1696 Example:
1697 mailers mymailers
1698 timeout mail 20s
1699 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017014. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001702----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001705 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001706 - frontend <name>
1707 - backend <name>
1708 - listen <name>
1709
1710A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1711its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1712section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001713section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001714
1715A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1716connections.
1717
1718A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1719to forward incoming connections.
1720
1721A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1722parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001724All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1725'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1726case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1727
1728Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1729logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1730proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1731However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1732name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1733
1734Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1735and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001736bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1738modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1739arbitrary criteria.
1740
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001741In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1742a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1743the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1744
1745 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1746 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1747 between responses and new requests.
1748
1749 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1750 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1751 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1752 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1753
1754 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1755 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1756 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1757
1758 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1759 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1760 client-facing connection remains open.
1761
1762 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1763 after the end of the response.
1764
1765The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1766frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1767following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1768weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1769
1770 Backend mode
1771
1772 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1773 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1774 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1775 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1776 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1777 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1778 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1779 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1780 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1781 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1782 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1783
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001784
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017864.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1787--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001789The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1790limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1791they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1792limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001793marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001794option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001795and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1796with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1797specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001799
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001800 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1801------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1802acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001803appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001804backlog X X X -
1805balance X - X X
1806bind - X X -
1807bind-process X X X X
1808block - X X X
1809capture cookie - X X -
1810capture request header - X X -
1811capture response header - X X -
1812clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001813compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1815cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001816declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001817default-server X - X X
1818default_backend X X X -
1819description - X X X
1820disabled X X X X
1821dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001822email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001823email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001824email-alert mailers X X X X
1825email-alert myhostname X X X X
1826email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827enabled X X X X
1828errorfile X X X X
1829errorloc X X X X
1830errorloc302 X X X X
1831-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1832errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001833force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001834filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001835fullconn X - X X
1836grace X X X X
1837hash-type X - X X
1838http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001839http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001840http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001841http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001842http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001843http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001844http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001845id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001846ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001847load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001848log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001849log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001850log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001851log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001852max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001853maxconn X X X -
1854mode X X X X
1855monitor fail - X X -
1856monitor-net X X X -
1857monitor-uri X X X -
1858option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1859option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1860option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1861option allbackups (*) X - X X
1862option checkcache (*) X - X X
1863option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1864option contstats (*) X X X -
1865option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1866option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1867option forceclose (*) X X X X
1868-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1869option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001870option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001871option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001872option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001873option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001874option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001875option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001876option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001877option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1878option httpchk X - X X
1879option httpclose (*) X X X X
1880option httplog X X X X
1881option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001882option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001883option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001884option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001885option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1886option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1887option logasap (*) X X X -
1888option mysql-check X - X X
1889option nolinger (*) X X X X
1890option originalto X X X X
1891option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001892option pgsql-check X - X X
1893option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001894option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001895option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001896option smtpchk X - X X
1897option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1898option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1899option splice-request (*) X X X X
1900option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001901option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001902option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1903option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1904-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001905option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001906option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1907option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1908option tcpka X X X X
1909option tcplog X X X X
1910option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001911external-check command X - X X
1912external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001913persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1914rate-limit sessions X X X -
1915redirect - X X X
1916redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1917redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1918reqadd - X X X
1919reqallow - X X X
1920reqdel - X X X
1921reqdeny - X X X
1922reqiallow - X X X
1923reqidel - X X X
1924reqideny - X X X
1925reqipass - X X X
1926reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001927reqitarpit - X X X
1928reqpass - X X X
1929reqrep - X X X
1930-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001931reqtarpit - X X X
1932retries X - X X
1933rspadd - X X X
1934rspdel - X X X
1935rspdeny - X X X
1936rspidel - X X X
1937rspideny - X X X
1938rspirep - X X X
1939rsprep - X X X
1940server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001941server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001942source X - X X
1943srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001944stats admin - X X X
1945stats auth X X X X
1946stats enable X X X X
1947stats hide-version X X X X
1948stats http-request - X X X
1949stats realm X X X X
1950stats refresh X X X X
1951stats scope X X X X
1952stats show-desc X X X X
1953stats show-legends X X X X
1954stats show-node X X X X
1955stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001956-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1957stick match - - X X
1958stick on - - X X
1959stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001960stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001961stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001962tcp-check connect - - X X
1963tcp-check expect - - X X
1964tcp-check send - - X X
1965tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001966tcp-request connection - X X -
1967tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001968tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001969tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001970tcp-response content - - X X
1971tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001972timeout check X - X X
1973timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001974timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001975timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1976timeout connect X - X X
1977timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1978timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1979timeout http-request X X X X
1980timeout queue X - X X
1981timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001982timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001983timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1984timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001985timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001986transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001987unique-id-format X X X -
1988unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001989use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001990use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001991------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1992 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019954.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1996---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001997
1998This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1999
2000
2001acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2002 Declare or complete an access list.
2003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2004 no | yes | yes | yes
2005 Example:
2006 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2007 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2008 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002010 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011
2012
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002013appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2014 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002015 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2017 no | no | yes | yes
2018 Arguments :
2019 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2020 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2021
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002022 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023 checked in each cookie value.
2024
2025 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2026 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2027 milliseconds.
2028
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002029 request-learn
2030 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2031 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2032 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2033 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2034 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2035 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2036
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002037 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2038 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2039 data following this prefix.
2040
2041 Example :
2042 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2043
2044 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2045 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2046
2047 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2048 2 modes are currently supported :
2049 - path-parameters :
2050 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2051 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2052 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2053 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2054 - query-string :
2055 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2056 query string.
2057
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002058 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2059 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2060 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002062 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2063 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064
2065
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002066backlog <conns>
2067 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2069 yes | yes | yes | no
2070 Arguments :
2071 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2072 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002073 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002074
2075 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2076 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2077 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2078 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2079 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2080 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2081 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2082 backlog parameter.
2083
2084 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2085 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2086 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2087
2088 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2089
2090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002092balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2095 yes | no | yes | yes
2096 Arguments :
2097 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2098 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2099 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2100 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2101
2102 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2103 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2104 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2105 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002106 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002107 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002108 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2109 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2110 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2111 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2112 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2113 it, so that you don't worry.
2114
2115 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2116 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2117 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2118 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2119 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2120 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2121 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2122 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002124 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2125 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2126 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2127 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2128 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2129 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2130 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2131 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2132
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002133 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002134 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002135 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2136 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002137 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002138 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2139 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2140 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2141 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2142 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002143 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2144 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2145 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2146 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2147 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2148 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002149
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2151 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2152 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2153 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2154 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2155 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2156 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2157 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002158 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002160 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2161 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2162 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002164 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2165 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2166 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2167 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2168 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2169 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2170 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2171 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2172 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2173 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2174 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2175 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002176
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002177 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002178 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2179 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2180 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2181 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2182 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2183 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2184 URIs start with a leading "/".
2185
2186 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2187 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2188 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2189 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002191 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002192 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2193
2194 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002195 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2196 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002197 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2198 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2199 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2200 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002201 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002202 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2203 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002204
2205 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2206 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2207 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2208 server will receive the request.
2209
2210 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2211 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2212 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2213 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2214 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002215 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2216 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2217 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002218
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002219 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2220 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2221 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2222 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2223 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002225 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002226 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2227 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2228 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2229
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002230 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2231 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2232 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2233
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002234 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002235 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002236 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2237 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2238 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2239 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2240 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2241 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002242 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002243 used instead.
2244
2245 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2246 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2247 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2248 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2249
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002250 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2251 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2252 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2253
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002254 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002256 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002257 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2258 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002259
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002260 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2261 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2262 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263
2264 Examples :
2265 balance roundrobin
2266 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002267 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002268 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2269 balance hdr(host)
2270 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002271
2272 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2273 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002275 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002276 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2277 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2278 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2279 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2280
2281 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2282 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2283 defaults to 16 kB.
2284
2285 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2286 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2287
2288 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2289 Round Robin.
2290
2291 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2292 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2293 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2294 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2295
2296 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2297
2298 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002299 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002300 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2301 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2302 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002303
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002304 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305
2306
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002307bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2308bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2311 no | yes | yes | no
2312 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002313 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2314 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2315 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2316 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002317 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002318 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2319 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2320 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2321 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2322 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2323 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2324 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002325 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2326 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2327 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2328 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2329 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2330 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2331 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002332 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2333 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2334 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002335 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2336 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2337 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002338
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002339 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2340 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002341 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2342 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2343 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002344 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2345 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2346 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2347 the range.
2348
2349 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2350 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2351 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2352 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2353 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2354 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2355 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002356 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002357 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002358
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002359 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2360 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2361 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2362 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2363 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2364 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2365 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2366 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002368 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2369 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2370 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2371 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2374 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2375 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2376 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2377 in a frontend.
2378
2379 Example :
2380 listen http_proxy
2381 bind :80,:443
2382 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002383 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002385 listen http_https_proxy
2386 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002387 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002388
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002389 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2390 bind ipv6@:80
2391 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2392 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2393
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002394 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002395 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002396
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002397 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2398 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2399 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2400 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2401 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2402
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002403 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002404 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002405
2406
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002407bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002408 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2410 yes | yes | yes | yes
2411 Arguments :
2412 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2413 may be used to override a default value.
2414
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002415 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002416 option may be combined with other numbers.
2417
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002418 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002419 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2420 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2421 missing from all processes.
2422
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002423 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002424 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002425 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2426 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2427 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2428 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002429
2430 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2431 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2432 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2433 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2434 and 'even' instances.
2435
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002436 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2437 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2438 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2439 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002440
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002441 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2442 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2443
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002444 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2445 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2446 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2447
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002448 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2449 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2450
2451 Example :
2452 listen app_ip1
2453 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002454 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002455
2456 listen app_ip2
2457 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002458 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002459
2460 listen management
2461 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002462 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002463
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002464 listen management
2465 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2466 bind-process 1-4
2467
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002468 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002469
2470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002471block { if | unless } <condition>
2472 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2474 no | yes | yes | yes
2475
2476 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2477 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002478 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002479 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2481 "block" statements per instance.
2482
2483 Example:
2484 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2485 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2486 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2487 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002489 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002490
2491
2492capture cookie <name> len <length>
2493 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2495 no | yes | yes | no
2496 Arguments :
2497 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2498 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2499 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2500 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2501 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2502
2503 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2504 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2505 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2506 right if it exceeds <length>.
2507
2508 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2509 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2510 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2511 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2512
2513 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2514 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2515 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2516
2517 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2518 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2519 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002520 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2521 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2522 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523
2524 Example:
2525 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2526
2527 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002528 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529
2530
2531capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002532 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2534 no | yes | yes | no
2535 Arguments :
2536 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002537 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2539 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2540 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2541
2542 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2543 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2544 it exceeds <length>.
2545
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002546 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2548 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002549 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2550 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2551 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2552 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002553 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002554 environments to find where the request came from.
2555
2556 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2557 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2558 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2559 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002560
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002561 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2562 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2563 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2564 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2565 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566
2567 Example:
2568 capture request header Host len 15
2569 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002570 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002572 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573 about logging.
2574
2575
2576capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002577 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2579 no | yes | yes | no
2580 Arguments :
2581 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002582 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002583 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2584 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2585 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2586
2587 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2588 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2589 it exceeds <length>.
2590
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002591 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2593 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2594 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002595 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2596 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2597 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2598 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002600 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2601 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2602 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2603 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2604 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605
2606 Example:
2607 capture response header Content-length len 9
2608 capture response header Location len 15
2609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002610 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 about logging.
2612
2613
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002614clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2617 yes | yes | yes | no
2618 Arguments :
2619 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2620 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2621 as explained at the top of this document.
2622
2623 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2624 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2625 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2626 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2627 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2628 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2629 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2630 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002631 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2633 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2634
2635 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2636 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2637 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2638 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2639 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2640 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2641
2642 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2643 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2644
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002645 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2646 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002647
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002648compression algo <algorithm> ...
2649compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002650compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002651 Enable HTTP compression.
2652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2653 yes | yes | yes | yes
2654 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002655 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2656 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2657 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2658
2659 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002660 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2661 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2662 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002663
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002664 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002665 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002666
2667 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2668 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2669 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2670 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2671 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002672 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002673
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002674 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2675 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2676 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2677 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2678 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2679 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2680 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002681 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002682
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002683 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002684 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002685 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2686 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2687 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2688 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2689 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002690
2691 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2692 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2693 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2694 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2695 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002696 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2697 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2698 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2699 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2700 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002701 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2702 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002703
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002704 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002705 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2706 "Accept-Encoding" header
2707 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002708 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002709 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2710 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002711 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2712 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2713 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2714 "multipart"
2715 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2716 header
2717 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2718 and later
2719 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2720 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002721
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002722 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2723 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002724
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002725 Examples :
2726 compression algo gzip
2727 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002728
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002729
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002730contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2733 yes | no | yes | yes
2734 Arguments :
2735 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2736 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2737 as explained at the top of this document.
2738
2739 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002740 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002741 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2743 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2744 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2745 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2746
2747 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2748 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2749 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2750 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2751 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2752 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2753
2754 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2755 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2756 instead.
2757
2758 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2759 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2760
2761
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002762cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002763 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2764 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2767 yes | no | yes | yes
2768 Arguments :
2769 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2770 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2771 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2772 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2773 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2774 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2775 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2776 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2777 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2778
2779 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2780 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2781 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2782 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2783 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2784 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002785 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2786 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2787 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2788 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2789 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790
2791 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002792 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002793
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002794 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002795 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2796 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2797 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2798 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2799 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2800 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2801 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2802 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2803 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2804 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805
2806 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2807 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2808 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2809 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2810 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2811 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2812 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2813 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2814 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002815 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002816 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2817 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2818 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002820 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2821 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2822 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002823 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2824 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2825 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2826 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002827 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2828 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2829 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
2831 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2832 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2833 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2834 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2835 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2836 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2837 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2838 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2839 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2840
2841 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2842 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2843 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2844 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2845 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2846 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2847 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2848 persistence cookie in the cache.
2849 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2850
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002851 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2852 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2853 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2854 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2855 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2856 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2857 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2858 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2859 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2860 they logout.
2861
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002862 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2863 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2864 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2865 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2866
2867 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2868 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2869 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2870 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2871 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2872 this attribute.
2873
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002874 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002875 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002876 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2877 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2878 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2879 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2880 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2881 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002882
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002883 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2884 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2885 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2886 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2887 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2888 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2889 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2890 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2891 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2892 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2893 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2894 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2895 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2896 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2897 the site.
2898
2899 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2900 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2901 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2902 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2903 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2904 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2905 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2906 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2907 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2908 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2909 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2910 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2911 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2912 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2913 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2914 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002916 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2917 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2918 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2919 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002920
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002921 Examples :
2922 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2923 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2924 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002925 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002926
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002927 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002929
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002930declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2931 Declares a capture slot.
2932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2933 no | yes | yes | no
2934 Arguments:
2935 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2936
2937 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2938 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2939 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2940 for use in the response.
2941
2942 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002943 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002944 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2945
2946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002947default-server [param*]
2948 Change default options for a server in a backend
2949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2950 yes | no | yes | yes
2951 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002952 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2953 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2954 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2955 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002956
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002957 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002958 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2959
2960 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963default_backend <backend>
2964 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2966 yes | yes | yes | no
2967 Arguments :
2968 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2969
2970 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2971 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2972 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2973 will catch all undetermined requests.
2974
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975 Example :
2976
2977 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2978 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2979 default_backend dynamic
2980
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002981 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002983
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002984description <string>
2985 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2987 no | yes | yes | yes
2988 Arguments : string
2989
2990 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2991 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2992 it describes.
2993 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2994
2995
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002996disabled
2997 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2999 yes | yes | yes | yes
3000 Arguments : none
3001
3002 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3003 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3004 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3005 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3006 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3007 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3008 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3009
3010 See also : "enabled"
3011
3012
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003013dispatch <address>:<port>
3014 Set a default server address
3015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3016 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003017 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003018
3019 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3020 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3021 during start-up.
3022
3023 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3024 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3025 possible with normal servers.
3026
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003027 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003028 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3029 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3030 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3031 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3032
3033 See also : "server"
3034
3035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036enabled
3037 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 yes | yes | yes | yes
3040 Arguments : none
3041
3042 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3043 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3044
3045 See also : "disabled"
3046
3047
3048errorfile <code> <file>
3049 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3051 yes | yes | yes | yes
3052 Arguments :
3053 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003054 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3055 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003056
3057 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003058 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003059 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003060 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3061 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062
3063 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3064 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3065 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3066
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003067 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3070 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3071 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3072 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3073
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003074 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3075 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3076 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3077 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3078 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3079 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3080
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3082 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3083 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003084 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3086
3087 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3088
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003089 Example :
3090 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003091 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003092 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3093 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3094
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003095
3096errorloc <code> <url>
3097errorloc302 <code> <url>
3098 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 yes | yes | yes | yes
3101 Arguments :
3102 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003103 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003104
3105 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3106 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3107 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3108 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3109 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3110
3111 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3112 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3113 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3114
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003115 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3116
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003117 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3118 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3119 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3120 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003121 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003122 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3123 request.
3124
3125 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3126
3127
3128errorloc303 <code> <url>
3129 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3131 yes | yes | yes | yes
3132 Arguments :
3133 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3134 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3135
3136 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3137 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3138 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3139 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3140 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3141
3142 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3143 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3144 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3145
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003146 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3147
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003148 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3149 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3150 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3151 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003152 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003153
3154 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3155
3156
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003157email-alert from <emailaddr>
3158 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3159 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3160 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3161 yes | yes | yes | yes
3162
3163 Arguments :
3164
3165 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3166
3167 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3168 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3169
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003170 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003171 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3172 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003173
3174
3175email-alert level <level>
3176 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3177 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3179 yes | yes | yes | yes
3180
3181 Arguments :
3182
3183 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3184 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3185 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3186
3187 By default level is alert
3188
3189 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3190 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3191 for the proxy.
3192
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003193 Alerts are sent when :
3194
3195 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3196 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3197 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3198 is notice or lower
3199 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3200 and a health check status update occurs
3201
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003202 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3203 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003204 section 3.6 about mailers.
3205
3206
3207email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3208 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3210 yes | yes | yes | yes
3211
3212 Arguments :
3213
3214 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3215
3216 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3217 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3218
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003219 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3220 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003221
3222
3223email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3224 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3225 mailers.
3226 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3227 yes | yes | yes | yes
3228
3229 Arguments :
3230
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003231 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003232
3233 By default the systems hostname is used.
3234
3235 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3236 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3237 for the proxy.
3238
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003239 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3240 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003241
3242
3243email-alert to <emailaddr>
3244 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3245 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3247 yes | yes | yes | yes
3248
3249 Arguments :
3250
3251 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3252
3253 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3254 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3255
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003256 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003257 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3258
3259
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003260force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3261 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3262 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3263 no | yes | yes | yes
3264
3265 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3266 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3267 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3268 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3269 marked down for maintenance operations.
3270
3271 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3272 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3273 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3274 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3275 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3276 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3277 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3278 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3279 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3280
3281 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3282 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3283 is used.
3284
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003285 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003286 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003287
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003288
3289filter <name> [param*]
3290 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3292 no | yes | yes | yes
3293 Arguments :
3294 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3295 referenced in section 9.
3296
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003297 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003298 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003299 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3300 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003301
3302 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3303 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3304
3305 Example:
3306 listen
3307 bind *:80
3308
3309 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3310 filter compression
3311 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3312
3313 compression algo gzip
3314 compression offload
3315
3316 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3317
3318 See also : section 9.
3319
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003320
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003321fullconn <conns>
3322 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3324 yes | no | yes | yes
3325 Arguments :
3326 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3327 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3328
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003329 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003330 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003331 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003332 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3333 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3334 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3335 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3336 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003337 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003338
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003339 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3340 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003341 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3342 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3343 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003344
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003345 Example :
3346 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3347 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3348 # connections.
3349 backend dynamic
3350 fullconn 10000
3351 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3352 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3353
3354 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3355
3356
3357grace <time>
3358 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003360 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003361 Arguments :
3362 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3363 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3364 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3365
3366 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3367 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003368 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003369 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3370
3371 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3372 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3373 simplify it.
3374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003375
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003376hash-balance-factor <factor>
3377 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3379 yes | no | no | yes
3380 Arguments :
3381 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3382 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3383 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3384
3385 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3386 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3387 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3388 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3389 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3390 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3391 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3392
3393 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3394 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3395 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3396 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3397 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3398
3399 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3400
3401
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003402hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003403 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3405 yes | no | yes | yes
3406 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003407 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3408 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003409
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003410 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3411 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3412 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3413 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3414 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3415 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3416 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3417 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3418 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3419 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003420
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003421 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3422 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3423 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3424 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3425 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3426 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3427 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3428 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3429 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3430 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3431 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3432 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3433 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003434 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3435 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003436
3437 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3438
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003439 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003440 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3441 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3442 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003443 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3444 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3445 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003446
3447 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3448 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003449 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3450 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3451 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3452 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3453
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003454 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3455 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3456 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3457 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3458 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3459 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3460 parameter.
3461
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003462 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3463 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3464 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3465 used on strings.
3466
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003467 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3468
3469 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3470 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3471 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3472 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3473 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3474 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3475 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3476 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3477 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3478 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3479 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3480 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003481
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003482 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3483 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3484 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003485
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003486 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003487
3488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489http-check disable-on-404
3490 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003492 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003493 Arguments : none
3494
3495 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3496 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3497 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3498 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3499 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3500 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3501 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3502 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003503 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3504 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3505 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3506
3507 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3508
3509
3510http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003511 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003513 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003514 Arguments :
3515 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3516 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003517 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003518 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3519 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3520 details on the supported keywords.
3521
3522 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3523 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3524 with the usual backslash ('\').
3525
3526 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3527 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3528 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3529 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3530 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3531
3532 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003533 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003534 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3535 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3536 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3537
3538 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003539 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003540 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3541 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3542 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3543 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3544
3545 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003546 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003547 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3548 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3549 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3550 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3551 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3552 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3553 trace).
3554
3555 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003556 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003557 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3558 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3559 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3560 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3561 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3562 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3563
3564 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3565 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3566 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3567 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3568 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3569 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3570 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3571 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3572
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003573 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3574 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3575 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3576
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003577 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3578 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3579
3580 Examples :
3581 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003582 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003583
3584 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003585 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003586
3587 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003588 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003589
3590 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003591 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003592
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003593 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003594
3595
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003596http-check send-state
3597 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3599 yes | no | yes | yes
3600 Arguments : none
3601
3602 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3603 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3604 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3605 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3606 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3607
3608 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3609 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3610 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3611 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3612 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003613 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3614 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3615 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3616
3617 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3618 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3619 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3620
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003621 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3622 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3623 checked in multiple backends.
3624
3625 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3626 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3627
3628 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3629 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3630 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3631 one fails.
3632
3633 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3634 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3635 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3636
3637 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3638 server's queue.
3639
3640 Example of a header received by the application server :
3641 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3642 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3643
3644 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3645
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003646http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3647 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003648 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003649 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003650 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003651 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3652 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003653 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3654 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003655 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3656 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3657 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003658 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003659 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003660 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003661 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003662 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003663 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003664 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003665 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003666 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003667 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3668
3669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 no | yes | yes | yes
3671
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003672 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3673 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3674 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3675 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3676 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003677
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003678 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3679 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3680 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3681
3682 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003683 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3684 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3685 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3686 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003687
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003688 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3689 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3690 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3691 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3692 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3693 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3694 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3695 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3696 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003697 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003698 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3699 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003700
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003701 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3702 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3703 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3704 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3705 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3706
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003707 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3708 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3709 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003710 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3711 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003712
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003713 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3714 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3715 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3716 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3717 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3718 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3719 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3720 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3721
3722 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3723 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3724 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003725 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3726 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003727
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003728 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3729 <name>.
3730
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003731 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3732 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3733 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3734 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3735 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3736 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3737 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3738 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3739
3740 Example:
3741
3742 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3743
3744 applied to:
3745
3746 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3747
3748 outputs:
3749
3750 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3751
3752 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3753
3754 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3755 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3756 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3757 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3758 header.
3759
3760 Example:
3761
3762 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3763
3764 applied to:
3765
3766 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3767
3768 outputs:
3769
3770 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3771
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003772 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3773 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3774 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3775 it.
3776
3777 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3778 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3779 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3780 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3781 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3782 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3783
3784 Example :
3785 # prepend the host name before the path
3786 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3787
3788 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3789 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3790 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3791 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3792 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3793 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3794 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3795 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3796
3797 Example :
3798 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3799 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3800
3801 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3802 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3803 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3804 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3805 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3806 "set-query".
3807
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003808 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3809 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3810 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3811 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3812 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3813 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3814 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3815 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3816
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003817 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3818 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3819 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3820 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3821 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3822 another equipment.
3823
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003824 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3825 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3826 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3827 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3828 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3829 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3830 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3831 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3832
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003833 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3834 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3835 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3836 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3837 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3838 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3839 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3840 admin privileges.
3841
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003842 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3843 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3844 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3845 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3846 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3847 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3848 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3849 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3850
3851 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3852 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3853 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3854 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3855 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3856 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3857
3858 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3859 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3860 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3861 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3862 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3863 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3864
3865 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3866 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3867 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3868 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3869 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3870 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3871 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3872 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3873 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3874
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003875 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003876 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3877 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3878 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3879 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3880 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3881 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3882 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3883 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3884 request header" for more information.
3885
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003886 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3887 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3888 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3889 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003890 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3891 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003892
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003893 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3894 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3895 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3896 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3897 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3898 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3899 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3900 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3901 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3902 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3903 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3904 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3905
3906 These actions take one or two arguments :
3907 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3908 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3909 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3910 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3911
3912 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3913 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3914 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3915 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3916
3917 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3918 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3919 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3920 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3921 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3922 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3923 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3924 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3925
3926 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3927 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3928 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3929 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3930 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3931
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003932 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3933 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3934 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3935 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3936 continues.
3937
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003938 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3939 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3940 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3941 the actions evaluation continues.
3942
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003943 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3944 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3945 inline.
3946
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003947 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3948 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003949 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003950 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3951 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003952 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003953 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003954 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003955 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3956 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003957 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003958 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003959 and '_'.
3960
3961 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3962 followed by some converters.
3963
3964 Example:
3965
3966 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3967
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003968 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
3969 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
3970
3971 Example:
3972
3973 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
3974
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003975 - set-src <expr> :
3976 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3977 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3978 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3979 source IP for privacy.
3980
3981 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3982 followed by some converters.
3983
3984 Example:
3985
3986 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3987 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3988
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003989 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
3990 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003991
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003992 - set-src-port <expr> :
3993 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3994 expression.
3995
3996 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3997 followed by some converters.
3998
3999 Example:
4000
4001 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4002 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4003
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004004 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4005 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4006 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004007
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004008 - set-dst <expr> :
4009 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4010 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4011 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4012 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4013 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4014
4015 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4016 followed by some converters.
4017
4018 Example:
4019
4020 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4021 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4022
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004023 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4024 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4025
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004026 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4027 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4028 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4029 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4030
4031 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4032 followed by some converters.
4033
4034 Example:
4035
4036 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4037 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4038
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004039 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4040 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4041 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4042
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004043 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4044 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4045 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4046 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4047 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4048 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4049 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4050 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4051 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4052 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4053 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4054 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4055 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4056 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4057 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4058 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4059
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004060 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4061
4062 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4063 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004064 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4065 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4066
4067 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4068 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4069 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4070 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004071
4072 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004073 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4074 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4075 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004076
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004077 http-request allow if nagios
4078 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4079 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4080 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004081
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004082 Example:
4083 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004084 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004085
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004086 Example:
4087 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4088 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004089 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004090 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4091 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4092 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4093 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4094 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4095 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4096
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004097 Example:
4098 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4099 acl add path /addacl
4100 acl del path /delacl
4101
4102 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4103
4104 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4105 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4106
4107 Example:
4108 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4109 acl setmap path /setmap
4110 acl delmap path /delmap
4111
4112 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4113
4114 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4115 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4116
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004117 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4118 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004119
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004120http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004121 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004122 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004123 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4124 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004125 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004126 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4127 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4128 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4129 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004130 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004131 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004132 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004133 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004134 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004135 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004136 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004137 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004138 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004139 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4140
4141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4142 no | yes | yes | yes
4143
4144 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4145 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4146 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4147 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4148 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4149 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4150
4151 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4152 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4153 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4154 current section.
4155
4156 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4157 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4158 rules are evaluated.
4159
4160 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4161 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4162 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4163 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4164 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4165 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4166 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4167
4168 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4169 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4170 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4171 external users.
4172
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004173 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4174 <name>.
4175
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004176 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4177 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4178 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4179 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4180 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4181 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4182 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4183 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4184
4185 Example:
4186
4187 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4188
4189 applied to:
4190
4191 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4192
4193 outputs:
4194
4195 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4196
4197 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4198
4199 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4200 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4201 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4202 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4203 header.
4204
4205 Example:
4206
4207 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4208
4209 applied to:
4210
4211 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4212
4213 outputs:
4214
4215 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4216
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004217 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004218 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4219 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4220 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004221
4222 Example:
4223
4224 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4225 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004226 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4227 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004228
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004229 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4230 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4231 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4232 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4233 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4234 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4235 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4236 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4237
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004238 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4239 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4240 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4241 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4242 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4243 another equipment.
4244
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004245 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4246 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4247 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4248 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4249 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4250 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4251 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4252 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4253
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004254 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4255 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4256 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4257 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4258 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4259 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4260 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4261 admin privileges.
4262
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004263 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4264 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4265 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4266 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4267 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4268 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4269 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4270 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4271
4272 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4273 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4274 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4275 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4276 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4277 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4278
4279 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4280 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4281 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4282 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4283 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4284 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4285
4286 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4287 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4288 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4289 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4290 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4291 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4292 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4293 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4294 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4295
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004296 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4297 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4298 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4299 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4300 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4301 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4302 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4303 response header" for more information.
4304
4305 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4306 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4307 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4308 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4309 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004310 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4311 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004312
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004313 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4314 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4315 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4316 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4317 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4318 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4319
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004320 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4321 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4322 inline.
4323
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004324 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4325 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004326 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004327 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4328 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004329 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004330 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004331 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004332 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4333 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004334 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004335 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4336 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004337
4338 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4339 followed by some converters.
4340
4341 Example:
4342
4343 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4344
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004345 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4346 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4347
4348 Example:
4349
4350 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4351
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004352 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4353 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4354 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4355 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4356 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4357 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4358 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4359
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004360 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4361 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4362 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4363 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4364 continues.
4365
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004366 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4367 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4368 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4369 the actions evaluation continues.
4370
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004371 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4372 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4373 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4374 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4375 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4376 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4377 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4378 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4379 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4380 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4381 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4382 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4383 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4384 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4385 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4386 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4387
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004388 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4389
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004390 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004391 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4392 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004393 rules.
4394
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004395 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4396 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4397 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4398 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4399
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004400 Example:
4401 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4402
4403 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4404
4405 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4406 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4407
4408 Example:
4409 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4410
4411 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4412
4413 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4414 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4415
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004416 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4417 ACL usage.
4418
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004419
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004420http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4421 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4422
4423 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4424 yes | no | yes | yes
4425
4426 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4427 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4428 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4429 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4430 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4431 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4432
4433 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4434
4435 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4436 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4437 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4438 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4439 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4440 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4441 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4442 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4443 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4444 not checking any request past the first one.
4445
4446 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4447 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4448 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4449 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4450 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4451 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4452 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4453
4454 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4455 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4456 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4457 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4458 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4459 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4460 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4461 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4462 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4463 downsides of rare connection failures.
4464
4465 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4466 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4467 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4468 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4469 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4470 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4471 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4472 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4473 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4474 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4475 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4476 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4477
4478 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4479 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4480 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4481 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4482
4483 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4484 and are never shared ;
4485
4486 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4487 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4488 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4489 and are never shared ;
4490
4491 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4492 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4493 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4494
4495 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4496 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4497 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4498
4499 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4500
4501
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004502http-send-name-header [<header>]
4503 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4504
4505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4506 yes | no | yes | yes
4507
4508 Arguments :
4509
4510 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4511
4512 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4513 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4514 is added with the header string proved.
4515
4516 See also : "server"
4517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004518id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004519 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4521 no | yes | yes | yes
4522 Arguments : none
4523
4524 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4525 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4526 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004527
4528
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004529ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4530 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 no | yes | yes | yes
4533
4534 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4535 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4536 and running).
4537
4538 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4539 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4540 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004541 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004542 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4543
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004544 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4545 "unless" condition is met.
4546
4547 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4548
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004549load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4550 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4552 yes | no | yes | yes
4553
4554 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4555 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4556 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4557 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4558 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4559 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4560 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4561 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4562
4563 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4564 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004565 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004566
4567 Arguments:
4568 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4569 named "server-state-file".
4570
4571 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4572 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4573 name is used as a file name.
4574
4575 none don't load any stat for this backend
4576
4577 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004578 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4579 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4580 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4581 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4582 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004583
4584 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4585 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4586
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004587 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004588
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004589 global
4590 stats socket /tmp/socket
4591 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004592
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004593 defaults
4594 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004595
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004596 backend bk
4597 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4598 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004599
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004600
4601 Then one can run :
4602
4603 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4604
4605 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4606
4607 1
4608 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4609 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4610 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4611
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004612 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004613
4614 global
4615 stats socket /tmp/socket
4616 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4617
4618 defaults
4619 load-server-state-from-file local
4620
4621 backend bk
4622 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4623 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4624
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004625
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004626 Then one can run :
4627
4628 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4629
4630 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4631
4632 1
4633 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4634 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4635 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4636
4637 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4638 "show servers state"
4639
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004640
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004641log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004642log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004643no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004644 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004647
4648 Prefix :
4649 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4650 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4651 prefix does not allow arguments.
4652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004653 Arguments :
4654 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4655 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4656 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4657 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4658 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4659 parameter.
4660
4661 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4662 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4663
4664 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4665 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4666 standard syslog port).
4667
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004668 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4669 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4670 standard syslog port).
4671
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004672 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4673 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4674 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4675 appropriately writeable).
4676
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004677 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4678 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004679
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004680 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4681 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4682 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4683 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4684 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4685 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4686 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4687 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4688 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4689 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4690 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4691
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004692 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4693
4694 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4695 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4696 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4697
4698 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4699 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4700 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004701 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4702 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4703 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4704 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4705 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004706
4707 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4708
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004709 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4710 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4711 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004712
4713 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4714 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4715 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4716 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4717
4718 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4719 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004720
4721 Example :
4722 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004723 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4724 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004725 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004726
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004727
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004728log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004729 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4731 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004732
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004733 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4734 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4735 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4736 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4737 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004738
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004739log-format-sd <string>
4740 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4742 yes | yes | yes | no
4743
4744 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4745 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4746 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4747 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4748 which covers the log format string in depth.
4749
4750 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4751 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4752
4753 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4754 log format to "rfc5424".
4755
4756 Example :
4757 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4758
4759
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004760log-tag <string>
4761 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | yes | yes | yes
4764
4765 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4766 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4767 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4768 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4769 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4770 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4771 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4772 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4773 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004774
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004775max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4776 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4778 yes | no | yes | yes
4779
4780 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4781 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4782 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4783 servers.
4784
4785 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4786 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4787 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4788 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4789 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4790 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4791 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4792 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4793 picking a different server.
4794
4795 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4796 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4797 even if they have to be queued.
4798
4799 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4800 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4801
4802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004803maxconn <conns>
4804 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4806 yes | yes | yes | no
4807 Arguments :
4808 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4809 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4810 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4811 closes.
4812
4813 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4814 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4815 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4816 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004817 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4818 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4819 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4820 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004821
4822 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4823 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4824 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4825
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004826 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4827
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004828 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4829
4830
4831mode { tcp|http|health }
4832 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 yes | yes | yes | yes
4835 Arguments :
4836 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4837 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4838 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4839 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4840
4841 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4842 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4843 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4844 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4845 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4846
4847 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004848 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4849 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4850 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4851 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4852 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4853 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4854 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004855
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004856 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4857 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4858 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004859
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004860 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004861 defaults http_instances
4862 mode http
4863
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004864 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004866
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004867monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004868 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4870 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871 Arguments :
4872 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4873 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004874 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004875 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4876 backend and its backup.
4877
4878 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4879 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4880 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4881 servers in a list of backends.
4882
4883 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4884 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4885 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4886 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4887 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4888 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4889 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004890 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4891 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004892
4893 Example:
4894 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004895 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004896 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4897 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4898 monitor-uri /site_alive
4899 monitor fail if site_dead
4900
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004901 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004902
4903
4904monitor-net <source>
4905 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 yes | yes | yes | no
4908 Arguments :
4909 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4910 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4911 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4912 followed by a mask.
4913
4914 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4915 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004916 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004917 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4918
4919 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4920 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4921 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4922 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004923 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4924 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4925 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004927 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4928 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4929 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4930 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4931 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4932 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004934 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4935 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004936
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004937 Example :
4938 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4939 frontend www
4940 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4941
4942 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4943
4944
4945monitor-uri <uri>
4946 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4948 yes | yes | yes | no
4949 Arguments :
4950 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4951 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4952
4953 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4954 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4955 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4956 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4957 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4958 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4959 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4960 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4961
4962 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4963 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4964 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4965 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4966 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4967 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4968
4969 Example :
4970 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4971 frontend www
4972 mode http
4973 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4974
4975 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4976
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004977
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004978option abortonclose
4979no option abortonclose
4980 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4982 yes | no | yes | yes
4983 Arguments : none
4984
4985 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4986 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4987 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4988 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004989 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004990 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4991 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4992 encountered while delivering the response.
4993
4994 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4995 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4996 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4997 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4998 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4999 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005000 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005001 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005002 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005003 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5004 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5005 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5006
5007 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5008 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5009 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5010 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5011 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5012 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5013 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5014 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005015 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005016
5017 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5018 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5019
5020 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5021
5022
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005023option accept-invalid-http-request
5024no option accept-invalid-http-request
5025 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | yes | yes | no
5028 Arguments : none
5029
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005030 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005031 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5032 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5033 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5034 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5035 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5036 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5037 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005038 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5039 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5040 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5041 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5042 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005043 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005044 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5045 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5046 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005047
5048 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5049 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5050 been confirmed.
5051
5052 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5053 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005054 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5055 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005056 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5057
5058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5060
5061 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5062 stats socket.
5063
5064
5065option accept-invalid-http-response
5066no option accept-invalid-http-response
5067 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5069 yes | no | yes | yes
5070 Arguments : none
5071
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005072 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005073 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5074 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5075 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5076 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5077 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5078 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5079 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005080 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5081 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5082 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005083
5084 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5085 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5086 been confirmed.
5087
5088 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5089 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5090 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5091 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5092
5093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5095
5096 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5097 stats socket.
5098
5099
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005100option allbackups
5101no option allbackups
5102 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5104 yes | no | yes | yes
5105 Arguments : none
5106
5107 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5108 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5109 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5110 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5111 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5112 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5113 order between the backup servers anymore.
5114
5115 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5116 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5117
5118 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5119 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5120
5121
5122option checkcache
5123no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005124 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 yes | no | yes | yes
5127 Arguments : none
5128
5129 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5130 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005131 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005132 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5133 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005134 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005135
5136 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005137 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005138 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005139 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5140 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005141 to the client are :
5142 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005143 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005144 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005145 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5146 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5147 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5148 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5149 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5150 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5151 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5152 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5153 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5154 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5155 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5156
5157 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005158 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005159 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005160 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005161 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5162
5163 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5164 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005165 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005166 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5167
5168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5170
5171
5172option clitcpka
5173no option clitcpka
5174 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 yes | yes | yes | no
5177 Arguments : none
5178
5179 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5180 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5181 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5182 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5183
5184 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5185 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5186 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5187 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5188
5189 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5190 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5191 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5192 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5193 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5194
5195 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5196
5197 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5198 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5199 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5200
5201 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5202 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5203
5204 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5205
5206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005207option contstats
5208 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 yes | yes | yes | no
5211 Arguments : none
5212
5213 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5214 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5215 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5216 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005217 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5218 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5219 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5220 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5221 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005222
5223
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005224option dontlog-normal
5225no option dontlog-normal
5226 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5228 yes | yes | yes | no
5229 Arguments : none
5230
5231 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5232 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5233 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5234 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5235 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5236 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5237 logged.
5238
5239 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5240 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5241 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005243 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005244 logging.
5245
5246
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005247option dontlognull
5248no option dontlognull
5249 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5251 yes | yes | yes | no
5252 Arguments : none
5253
5254 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5255 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5256 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5257 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5258 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5259 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005260 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5261 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5262 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005263
5264 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5265 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5266 would not be logged.
5267
5268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5270
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005271 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5272 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005273
5274
5275option forceclose
5276no option forceclose
5277 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005279 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005280 Arguments : none
5281
5282 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5283 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5284 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5285 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5286 global session times in the logs.
5287
5288 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005289 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005290 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005291
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005292 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5293 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5294 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5295
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005296 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5297 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005298
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5301
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005302 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005303
5304
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005305option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005306 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5308 yes | yes | yes | yes
5309 Arguments :
5310 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5311 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005312 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005313 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005314
5315 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5316 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5317 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5318 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5319 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5320 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5321 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005322 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5323 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5324 possible that the client has already brought one.
5325
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005326 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005327 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005328 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5329 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005330 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5331 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005332
5333 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5334 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5335 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5336 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5337 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5338 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5339 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5340
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005341 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5342 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5343 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5344 are under the control of the end-user.
5345
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005346 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005347 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5348 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005349 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5350 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5351 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005352
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005353 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005354 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5355 frontend www
5356 mode http
5357 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5358
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005359 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5360 backend www
5361 mode http
5362 option forwardfor header X-Client
5363
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005364 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005365 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005366
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005367
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005368option http-buffer-request
5369no option http-buffer-request
5370 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5372 yes | yes | yes | yes
5373 Arguments : none
5374
5375 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5376 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5377 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5378 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5379 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5380 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5381 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5382 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005383 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005384 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5385 default.
5386
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005387 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005388
5389
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005390option http-ignore-probes
5391no option http-ignore-probes
5392 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5394 yes | yes | yes | no
5395 Arguments : none
5396
5397 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5398 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5399 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5400 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5401 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5402 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5403 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5404 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5405 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5406 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5407 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5408 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5409
5410 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5411 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5412 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5413 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5414 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5415 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5416 are often the only way to detect them.
5417
5418 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5419 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5420
5421 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5422
5423
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005424option http-keep-alive
5425no option http-keep-alive
5426 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5428 yes | yes | yes | yes
5429 Arguments : none
5430
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005431 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5432 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5433 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5434 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5435 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5436 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5437 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5438
5439 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5440 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005441 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5442 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5443 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5444 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5445 situations where this option may be useful :
5446
5447 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5448 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5449
5450 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5451 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5452
5453 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5454 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5455 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5456 request.
5457
5458 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5459 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005460 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5461 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5462 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005463
5464 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5465 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5466
5467 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5468 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5469 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5470 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5471 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5472 not set.
5473
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005474 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5475 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005476 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005477 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005478
5479 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005480 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5481 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005482
5483
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005484option http-no-delay
5485no option http-no-delay
5486 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5488 yes | yes | yes | yes
5489 Arguments : none
5490
5491 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5492 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5493 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5494 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5495 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5496 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5497 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5498 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5499 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5500 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5501 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5502 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5503 affected.
5504
5505 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5506 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5507 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5508 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5509 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5510 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5511 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5512 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5513 latency environments.
5514
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005515 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5516
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005517
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005518option http-pretend-keepalive
5519no option http-pretend-keepalive
5520 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5522 yes | yes | yes | yes
5523 Arguments : none
5524
5525 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5526 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5527 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5528 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5529 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5530 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5531 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5532 consider the response complete.
5533
5534 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5535 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5536 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5537 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5538 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5539 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5540
5541 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5542 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5543 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5544 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5545 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5546 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5547 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5548
5549 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5550 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005551 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005552 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5553 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005554
5555 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5556 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5557
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005558 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5559 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005560
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005561
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005562option http-server-close
5563no option http-server-close
5564 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5566 yes | yes | yes | yes
5567 Arguments : none
5568
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005569 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5570 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5571 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5572 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5573 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5574 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5575 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5576 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5577 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5578 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5579 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5580 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5581 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5582 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5583 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5584 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005585
5586 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5587 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5588 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5589 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005590 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5591 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005592
5593 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5594 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005595 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5596 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005597 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5598 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005599
5600 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5601 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5602
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005603 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005604 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5605 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005606
5607
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005608option http-tunnel
5609no option http-tunnel
5610 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5612 yes | yes | yes | yes
5613 Arguments : none
5614
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005615 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5616 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5617 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5618 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5619 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5620 "option http-tunnel".
5621
5622 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005623 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005624 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5625 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5626 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5627 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5628 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5629 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5630 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005631
5632 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5633 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5634
5635 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5636 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5637 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5638
5639
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005640option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005641no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005642 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5644 yes | yes | yes | no
5645 Arguments : none
5646
5647 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5648 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5649 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5650 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5651 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5652 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5653 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5654
5655 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5656 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005657 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5658 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5659 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005660
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005661 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5662 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5663 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5664 front of an existing proxy.
5665
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005666 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5667
5668 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5669 http-server-close".
5670
5671
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005672option httpchk
5673option httpchk <uri>
5674option httpchk <method> <uri>
5675option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5676 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5678 yes | no | yes | yes
5679 Arguments :
5680 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5681 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5682 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5683 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5684 ones.
5685
5686 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5687 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5688 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5689
5690 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5691 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5692 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5693 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5694 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5695
5696 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5697 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5698 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5699 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5700 the lack of any response.
5701
5702 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5703
5704 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5705 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5706 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5707
5708 Examples :
5709 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5710 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5711 backend https_relay
5712 mode tcp
5713 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5714 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5715
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005716 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5717 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5718 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005719
5720
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005721option httpclose
5722no option httpclose
5723 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5725 yes | yes | yes | yes
5726 Arguments : none
5727
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005728 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5729 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5730 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5731 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005732 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005733 "option http-tunnel".
5734
5735 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5736 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5737 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5738 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5739 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5740 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5741 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5742 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005743
5744 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005745 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005746 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5747 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5748 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5749 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5750 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005751
5752 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5753 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005754 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5755 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005756 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5757 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005758
5759 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5760 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5761
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005762 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5763 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005764
5765
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005766option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005767 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005770 Arguments :
5771 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5772 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5773 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5774 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5775 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005776
5777 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5778 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5779 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5780 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5781 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5782 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5783 ports.
5784
5785 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5786
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005787 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5788 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005790 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005791
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005792
5793option http_proxy
5794no option http_proxy
5795 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5797 yes | yes | yes | yes
5798 Arguments : none
5799
5800 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5801 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5802 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5803 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5804 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5805
5806 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5807 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005808 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5809 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005810
5811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5813
5814 Example :
5815 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5816 backend direct_forward
5817 option httpclose
5818 option http_proxy
5819
5820 See also : "option httpclose"
5821
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005822
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005823option independent-streams
5824no option independent-streams
5825 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5827 yes | yes | yes | yes
5828 Arguments : none
5829
5830 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5831 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5832 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5833 receive data or not.
5834
5835 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5836 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5837 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5838 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5839 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5840 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5841 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5842 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5843 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5844 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5845 socket buffers.
5846
5847 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5848 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5849 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5850 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5851 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5852
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005853 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005854 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5855 deprecated.
5856
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005857 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005858
5859
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005860option ldap-check
5861 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 yes | no | yes | yes
5864 Arguments : none
5865
5866 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5867 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5868 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5869 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5870
5871 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5872 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5873
5874 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5875 configure it.
5876
5877 Example :
5878 option ldap-check
5879
5880 See also : "option httpchk"
5881
5882
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005883option external-check
5884 Use external processes for server health checks
5885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5886 yes | no | yes | yes
5887
5888 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5889 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5890 command".
5891
5892 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5893
5894 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5895
5896
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005897option log-health-checks
5898no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005899 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5901 yes | no | yes | yes
5902 Arguments : none
5903
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005904 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5905 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5906 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005907
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005908 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5909 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5910 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5911 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5912 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5913
5914 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5915 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005916
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005917 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5918 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5919 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005920
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005921
5922option log-separate-errors
5923no option log-separate-errors
5924 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5926 yes | yes | yes | no
5927 Arguments : none
5928
5929 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5930 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5931 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5932 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5933 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5934 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5935 provides very important information.
5936
5937 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5938 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5939 error logs.
5940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005941 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005942 logging.
5943
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005944
5945option logasap
5946no option logasap
5947 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5949 yes | yes | yes | no
5950 Arguments : none
5951
5952 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5953 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5954 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5955 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5956 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5957 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5958 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005959 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005960 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5961 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5962
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005963 Examples :
5964 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5965 mode http
5966 option httplog
5967 option logasap
5968 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5969
5970 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5971 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5972 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5973 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005975 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005976 logging.
5977
5978
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005979option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005980 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5982 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005983 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005984 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5985 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005986 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005987
5988 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5989 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5990 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5991 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5992 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5993 in the MySQL table, like this :
5994
5995 USE mysql;
5996 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5997 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5998
5999 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6000 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6001 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6002 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6003 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6004 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6005 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6006 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6007 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6008
6009 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6010 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006011
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006012 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006013
6014 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6015 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6016 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6017 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006018 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6019 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006020
6021 See also: "option httpchk"
6022
6023
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006024option nolinger
6025no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006026 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006027 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6028 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006029 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006030
6031 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6032 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6033 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6034 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6035 connections.
6036
6037 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6038 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6039 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6040 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6041 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6042 this too.
6043
6044 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6045 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6046 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6047
6048 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6049 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6050 for servers.
6051
6052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6054
6055
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006056option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6057 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6059 yes | yes | yes | yes
6060 Arguments :
6061 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6062 matching <network>
6063 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6064 header name.
6065
6066 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6067 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6068 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6069 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6070 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6071 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6072 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6073 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6074 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6075 possible that the client has already brought one.
6076
6077 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6078 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6079 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6080 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6081 header and requires different one.
6082
6083 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6084 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6085 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6086 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6087 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6088 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6089 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6090
6091 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6092 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6093 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6094 both are defined.
6095
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006096 Examples :
6097 # Original Destination address
6098 frontend www
6099 mode http
6100 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6101
6102 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6103 backend www
6104 mode http
6105 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6106
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006107 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6108 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006109
6110
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006111option persist
6112no option persist
6113 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6115 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006116 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006117
6118 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6119 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6120 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6121 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6122 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6123 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6124 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6125 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6126 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6127 redirected to another valid server.
6128
6129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6131
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006132 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006133
6134
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006135option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6136 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6138 yes | no | yes | yes
6139 Arguments :
6140 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6141 PostgreSQL server.
6142
6143 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6144 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6145 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6146 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6147
6148 See also: "option httpchk"
6149
6150
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006151option prefer-last-server
6152no option prefer-last-server
6153 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6154 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6155 yes | no | yes | yes
6156 Arguments : none
6157
6158 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6159 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6160 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6161 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6162 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6163 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6164 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6165 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6166 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006167 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6168 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6169 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6170 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6171 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6172 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6173 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006174
6175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6177
6178 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6179
6180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006181option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006182option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006183no option redispatch
6184 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006187 Arguments :
6188 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6189 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6190 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6191 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6192 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6193 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6194 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6195 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6196 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006198
6199 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6200 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6201 be able to access the service anymore.
6202
6203 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6204 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6205
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006206 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006207 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6208 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006210 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6211 "redisp" keywords.
6212
6213 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6214 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6215
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006216 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006217
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006218
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006219option redis-check
6220 Use redis health checks for server testing
6221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6222 yes | no | yes | yes
6223 Arguments : none
6224
6225 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6226 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6227 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6228 find the "+PONG" response message.
6229
6230 Example :
6231 option redis-check
6232
6233 See also : "option httpchk"
6234
6235
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006236option smtpchk
6237option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6238 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6240 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006241 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006242 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6243 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6244 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6245
6246 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6247 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6248 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6249
6250 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6251 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6252 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6253 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6254 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6255 dead server.
6256
6257 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6258 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6259 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6260 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6261
6262 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6263 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6264 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6265 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006266 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006267
6268 Example :
6269 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6270
6271 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006274option socket-stats
6275no option socket-stats
6276
6277 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 yes | yes | yes | no
6280
6281 Arguments : none
6282
6283
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006284option splice-auto
6285no option splice-auto
6286 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6288 yes | yes | yes | yes
6289 Arguments : none
6290
6291 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6292 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6293 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6294 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006295 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006296 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6297 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6298 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6299 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6300
6301 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6302 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6303 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6304 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6305 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6306 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6307 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6308 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6309 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6310 keyword.
6311
6312 Example :
6313 option splice-auto
6314
6315 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6316 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6317
6318 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6319 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6320
6321
6322option splice-request
6323no option splice-request
6324 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6326 yes | yes | yes | yes
6327 Arguments : none
6328
6329 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006330 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006331 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6332 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6333 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6334 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6335
6336 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6337
6338 Example :
6339 option splice-request
6340
6341 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6342 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6343
6344 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6345 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6346
6347
6348option splice-response
6349no option splice-response
6350 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6352 yes | yes | yes | yes
6353 Arguments : none
6354
6355 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006356 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006357 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6358 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6359 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6360 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6361
6362 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6363
6364 Example :
6365 option splice-response
6366
6367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6369
6370 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6371 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6372
6373
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006374option spop-check
6375 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6377 no | no | no | yes
6378 Arguments : none
6379
6380 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6381 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6382 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6383 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6384
6385 Example :
6386 option spop-check
6387
6388 See also : "option httpchk"
6389
6390
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006391option srvtcpka
6392no option srvtcpka
6393 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | no | yes | yes
6396 Arguments : none
6397
6398 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6399 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6400 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6401 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6402
6403 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6404 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6405 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6406 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6407
6408 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6409 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6410 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6411 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6412 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6413
6414 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6415
6416 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6417 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6418 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6419
6420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6422
6423 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6424
6425
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006426option ssl-hello-chk
6427 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6429 yes | no | yes | yes
6430 Arguments : none
6431
6432 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6433 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6434 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6435 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6436 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6437 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6438 hello message.
6439
6440 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6441 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6442 messages, which is appreciable.
6443
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006444 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6445 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6446 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006447
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006448 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6449
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006450
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006451option tcp-check
6452 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6453 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | no | yes | yes
6455
6456 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6457 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6458
6459 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6460 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6461 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6462
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006463 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006464 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6465 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6466 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6467 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6468 only.
6469
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006470 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006471 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6472 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6473 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6474 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6475
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006476 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006477 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6478 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006479 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006480 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6481 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6482 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6483 the respective protocols.
6484 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6485 analysed.
6486
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006487 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6488 script.
6489
6490 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6491 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6492 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6493 The "comment" is of course optional.
6494
6495
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006496 Examples :
6497 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6498 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006499 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006500
6501 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6502 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006503 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006504
6505 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6506 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006507 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006508 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006509 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006510 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006511 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006512 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006513 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6514 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006515 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006516 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6517 tcp-check expect string +OK
6518
6519 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6520 (send many headers before analyzing)
6521 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006522 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006523 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6524 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6525 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6526 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006527 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006528
6529
6530 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6531
6532
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006533option tcp-smart-accept
6534no option tcp-smart-accept
6535 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 yes | yes | yes | no
6538 Arguments : none
6539
6540 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6541 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6542 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6543 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6544 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6545 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6546
6547 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6548 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6549 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6550 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6551
6552 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6553 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6554 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6555 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6556
6557 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6558 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6559 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6560
6561 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6562 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6563 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6564
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006565 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6566
6567
6568option tcp-smart-connect
6569no option tcp-smart-connect
6570 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6572 yes | no | yes | yes
6573 Arguments : none
6574
6575 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6576 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6577 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6578 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6579 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6580
6581 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6582 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6583 complex.
6584
6585 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6586 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6587 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6588
6589 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6590 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6591
6592 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6593
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006594
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006595option tcpka
6596 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6598 yes | yes | yes | yes
6599 Arguments : none
6600
6601 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6602 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6603 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6604 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6605
6606 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6607 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6608 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6609 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6610
6611 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6612 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6613 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6614 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6615 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6616
6617 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6618
6619 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6620 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6621 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6622 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6623 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6624 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6625 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6626 backends.
6627
6628 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6629
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006630
6631option tcplog
6632 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6634 yes | yes | yes | yes
6635 Arguments : none
6636
6637 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6638 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6639 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6640 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6641 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6642 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6643 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6644 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6645
6646 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006648 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006649
6650
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006651option transparent
6652no option transparent
6653 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006655 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006656 Arguments : none
6657
6658 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6659 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6660 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6661 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6662 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6663 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6664 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6665 appropriate server.
6666
6667 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6668 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6669
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006670 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006671 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006672
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006673
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006674external-check command <command>
6675 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6677 yes | no | yes | yes
6678
6679 Arguments :
6680 <command> is the external command to run
6681
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006682 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6683
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006684 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006685
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006686 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6687 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6688 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6689 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6690 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6691 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006692
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006693 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6694
6695 Environment variables :
6696 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6697 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6698
6699 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6700
6701 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6702
6703 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6704 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6705 for a UNIX socket).
6706
6707 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6708
6709 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6710
6711 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6712
6713 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6714
6715 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6716
6717 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6718 socket).
6719
6720 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6721 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6722
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006723 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6724 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6725 failed.
6726
6727 Example :
6728 external-check command /bin/true
6729
6730 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6731
6732
6733external-check path <path>
6734 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | no | yes | yes
6737
6738 Arguments :
6739 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6740
6741 The default path is "".
6742
6743 Example :
6744 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6745
6746 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6747 "external-check command"
6748
6749
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006750persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006751persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006752 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6754 yes | no | yes | yes
6755 Arguments :
6756 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006757 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6758 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006759
6760 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6761 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6762 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6763 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6764 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6765 forwarded to this server.
6766
6767 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6768 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6769 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006770 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006771 a single "listen" section.
6772
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006773 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6774 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6775 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6776
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006777 Example :
6778 listen tse-farm
6779 bind :3389
6780 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6781 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6782 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6783 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6784 persist rdp-cookie
6785 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006786 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006787 balance rdp-cookie
6788 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6789 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6790
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006791 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6792 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006793
6794
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006795rate-limit sessions <rate>
6796 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6798 yes | yes | yes | no
6799 Arguments :
6800 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6801 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6802
6803 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6804 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6805 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6806 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6807 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6808 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6809
6810 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6811 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6812 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6813 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6814
6815 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6816 listen smtp
6817 mode tcp
6818 bind :25
6819 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006820 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006821
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006822 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6823 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6824 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006825
6826 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6827
6828
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006829redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6830redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6831redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006832 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6834 no | yes | yes | yes
6835
6836 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006837 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006838
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006839 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006840 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006841 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6842 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6843 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006844
6845 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6846 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6847 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6848 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6849 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006850 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6851 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6852 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6853 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006854
6855 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6856 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6857 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6858 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6859 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6860 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006861 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006862 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006863 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6864 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6865 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006866
6867 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006868 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6869 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6870 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006871 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006872 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6873 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6874 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6875 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006876
6877 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6878 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6879
6880 - "drop-query"
6881 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6882 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6883 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6884 with a location-type redirect.
6885
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006886 - "append-slash"
6887 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6888 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6889 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6890 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6891
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006892 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6893 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6894 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6895 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6896 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6897 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6898 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6899
6900 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6901 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6902 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6903 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6904 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6905 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6906 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006907
6908 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6909 acl clear dst_port 80
6910 acl secure dst_port 8080
6911 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006912 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006913 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006914 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6915
6916 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006917 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6918 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6919 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006920 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006921
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006922 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6923 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6924 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6925
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006926 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006927 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006928
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006929 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006930 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6931 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6932 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006934 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006935
6936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006937redisp (deprecated)
6938redispatch (deprecated)
6939 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6941 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006942 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006943
6944 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6945 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6946 be able to access the service anymore.
6947
6948 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6949 redistribute them to a working server.
6950
6951 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6952 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6953 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006955 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6956 "option redispatch" instead.
6957
6958 See also : "option redispatch"
6959
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006960
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006961reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006962 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6964 no | yes | yes | yes
6965 Arguments :
6966 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6967 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006968 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006969
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006970 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6971 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6972
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006973 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6974 the last header of an HTTP request.
6975
6976 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6977 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6978 responses.
6979
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006980 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6981 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6982 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6983
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006984 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6985 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006986
6987
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006988reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6989reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006990 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6992 no | yes | yes | yes
6993 Arguments :
6994 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6995 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6996 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6997 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6998 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6999 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7000 ignores case.
7001
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007002 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7003 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7004
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007005 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7006 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7007 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7008 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007009 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007010
7011 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7012 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7013
7014 Example :
7015 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7016 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7017 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7018
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007019 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7020 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007021
7022
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007023reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7024reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007025 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7027 no | yes | yes | yes
7028 Arguments :
7029 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7030 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7031 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7032 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7033 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7034 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7035
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007036 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7037 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7038
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007039 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7040 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7041 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7042 next servers.
7043
7044 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7045 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7046 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7047
7048 Example :
7049 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7050 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7051 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7052
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007053 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7054 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007055
7056
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007057reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7058reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007059 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7061 no | yes | yes | yes
7062 Arguments :
7063 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7064 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7065 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7066 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7067 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7068 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7069 case.
7070
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007071 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7072 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7073
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007074 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7075 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7076 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7077 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007078 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007079
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007080 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007081 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007082 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007083
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007084 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7085 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7086
7087 Example :
7088 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7089 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7090 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7091
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007092 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7093 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007094
7095
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007096reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7097reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007098 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7100 no | yes | yes | yes
7101 Arguments :
7102 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7103 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7104 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7105 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7106 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7107 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7108 case.
7109
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007110 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7111 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7112
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007113 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7114 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7115 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7116 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7117
7118 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7119 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7120
7121 Example :
7122 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7123 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7124 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7125 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7126
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007127 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7128 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007129
7130
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007131reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7132reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007133 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7135 no | yes | yes | yes
7136 Arguments :
7137 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7138 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7139 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7140 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7141 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7142 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7143
7144 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7145 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7146 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7147 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007148 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007149
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007150 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7151 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7152
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007153 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7154 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7155 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7156
7157 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7158 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7159 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7160 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7161 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7162
7163 Example :
7164 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007165 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007166 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7167 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7168
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007169 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7170 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007171
7172
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007173reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7174reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007175 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7177 no | yes | yes | yes
7178 Arguments :
7179 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7180 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7181 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7182 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7183 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7184 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7185 ignores case.
7186
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007187 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7188 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7189
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007190 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7191 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007192 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7193 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7194 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007195 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7196 not set.
7197
7198 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7199 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7200 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7201 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7202 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7203
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007204 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007205 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7206 # block all others.
7207 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7208 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7209
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007210 # block bad guys
7211 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7212 reqitarpit . if badguys
7213
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007214 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7215 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007216
7217
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007218retries <value>
7219 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7221 yes | no | yes | yes
7222 Arguments :
7223 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7224 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7225 default value is 3.
7226
7227 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7228 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7229 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7230
7231 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007232 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7233 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007234
7235 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7236 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7237
7238 See also : "option redispatch"
7239
7240
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007241rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007242 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7244 no | yes | yes | yes
7245 Arguments :
7246 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7247 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007248 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007249
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007250 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7251 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7252
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007253 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7254 the last header of an HTTP response.
7255
7256 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7257 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7258 responses.
7259
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007260 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7261 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007262
7263
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007264rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7265rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007266 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7268 no | yes | yes | yes
7269 Arguments :
7270 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7271 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7272 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7273 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7274 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7275 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7276 ignores case.
7277
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007278 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7279 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7280
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007281 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7282 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007283 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007284 client.
7285
7286 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7287 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7288 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7289
7290 Example :
7291 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007292 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007293
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007294 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7295 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007296
7297
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007298rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7299rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007300 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 no | yes | yes | yes
7303 Arguments :
7304 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7305 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7306 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7307 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7308 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7309 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7310 ignores case.
7311
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007312 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7313 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7314
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007315 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7316 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7317 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7318 case-sensitive.
7319
7320 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007321 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7322 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7323 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007324
7325 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7326 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7327
7328 Example :
7329 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7330 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7331
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007332 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7333 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007334
7335
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007336rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7337rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007338 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 no | yes | yes | yes
7341 Arguments :
7342 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7343 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7344 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7345 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7346 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7347 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7348 ignores case.
7349
7350 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7351 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7352 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7353 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007354 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007355
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007356 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7357 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7358
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007359 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7360 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7361 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7362
7363 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7364 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7365 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7366 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7367 are not case-sensitive.
7368
7369 Example :
7370 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7371 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7372
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007373 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7374 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007375
7376
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007377server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007378 Declare a server in a backend
7379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7380 no | no | yes | yes
7381 Arguments :
7382 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007383 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007384 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007385
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007386 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7387 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7388 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7389 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007390 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7391 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7392 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7393 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7394 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007395 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7396 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7397 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7398 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7399 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7400 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7401 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007402 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007403 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7404 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007405 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7406 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007407
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007408 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007409 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7410 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7411 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7412 adding this value to the client's port.
7413
7414 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7415 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007416 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007417
7418 Examples :
7419 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7420 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007421 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007422 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7423 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7424 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007425
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007426 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7427 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7428 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7429 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7430 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7431
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007432 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7433 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007434
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007435server-state-file-name [<file>]
7436 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7437 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7438 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7439 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7440 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7441 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7442
7443 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7444 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7445
7446 global
7447 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7448
7449 backend bk
7450 load-server-state-from-file
7451
7452 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7453 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007454
7455source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007456source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007457source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007458 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7460 yes | no | yes | yes
7461 Arguments :
7462 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7463 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007464
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007465 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007466 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7467 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7468 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7469 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7470 supported prefixes are :
7471 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7472 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7473 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007474 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007475 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7476 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007477
7478 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7479 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007480 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7481 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7482 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007483
7484 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7485 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7486 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7487 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7488 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7489 <addr>.
7490
7491 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7492 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7493 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7494 port.
7495
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007496 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7497 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7498 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7499 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007500 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007501 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7502 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7503 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7504 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7505 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7506 HTTP header.
7507
7508 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7509 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007510 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007511 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7512 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7513 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7514 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7515 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7516 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7517 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7518
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007519 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7520 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7521 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7522 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7523 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7524 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7525
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007526 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7527 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7528 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7529 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7530
7531 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7532 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7533 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7534 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7535 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7536 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7537
7538 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7539 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7540 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7541 there are two methods :
7542
7543 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7544 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7545 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7546 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7547 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7548 of the client ranges may be used.
7549
7550 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7551 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7552 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7553 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7554 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7555 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7556 same session.
7557
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007558 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7559 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7560 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007561 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007562
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007563 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7564
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007565 Examples :
7566 backend private
7567 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7568 source 192.168.1.200
7569
7570 backend transparent_ssl1
7571 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7572 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7573
7574 backend transparent_ssl2
7575 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7576 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7577 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7578
7579 backend transparent_ssl3
7580 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7581 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7582 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7583
7584 backend transparent_smtp
7585 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7586 # with Tproxy version 4.
7587 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7588
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007589 backend transparent_http
7590 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7591 # proxy.
7592 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007594 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007595 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007597
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007598srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7599 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7601 yes | no | yes | yes
7602 Arguments :
7603 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7604 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7605 as explained at the top of this document.
7606
7607 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7608 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7609 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7610 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7611 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7612 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7613 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7614
7615 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7616 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7617 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7618 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7619 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007620 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007621 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007622 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007623
7624 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7625 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7626 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7627 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7628 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7629 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7630
7631 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7632 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7633
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007634 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7635 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007636
7637
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007638stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7639 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007641 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007642
7643 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7644 matched.
7645
7646 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7647 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7648
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007649 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7650 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7651 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7652
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007653 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7654 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7655 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7656 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007657
7658 Example :
7659 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7660 backend stats_localhost
7661 stats enable
7662 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7663
7664 Example :
7665 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7666 backend stats_auth
7667 stats enable
7668 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7669 stats admin if TRUE
7670
7671 Example :
7672 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7673 userlist stats-auth
7674 group admin users admin
7675 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7676 group readonly users haproxy
7677 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7678
7679 backend stats_auth
7680 stats enable
7681 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7682 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7683 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7684 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7685
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007686 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7687 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7688 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007689
7690
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007691stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7692 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007694 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007695 Arguments :
7696 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7697
7698 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7699
7700 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7701 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7702 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7703 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7704 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7705 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7706
7707 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7708 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7709 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007710 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007711
7712 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7713 report using "stats scope".
7714
7715 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7716 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7717 unobvious parameters.
7718
7719 Example :
7720 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7721 backend public_www
7722 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7723 stats enable
7724 stats hide-version
7725 stats scope .
7726 stats uri /admin?stats
7727 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7728 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7729 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7730
7731 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7732 backend private_monitoring
7733 stats enable
7734 stats uri /admin?stats
7735 stats refresh 5s
7736
7737 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7738
7739
7740stats enable
7741 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007743 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007744 Arguments : none
7745
7746 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7747 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7748 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7749 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7750 - stats auth : no authentication
7751 - stats scope : no restriction
7752
7753 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7754 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7755 unobvious parameters.
7756
7757 Example :
7758 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7759 backend public_www
7760 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7761 stats enable
7762 stats hide-version
7763 stats scope .
7764 stats uri /admin?stats
7765 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7766 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7767 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7768
7769 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7770 backend private_monitoring
7771 stats enable
7772 stats uri /admin?stats
7773 stats refresh 5s
7774
7775 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7776
7777
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007778stats hide-version
7779 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007781 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007782 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007783
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007784 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7785 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7786 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7787 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7788 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7789 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007791 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7792 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7793 unobvious parameters.
7794
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007795 Example :
7796 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7797 backend public_www
7798 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007799 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007800 stats hide-version
7801 stats scope .
7802 stats uri /admin?stats
7803 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7804 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7805 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007806
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007807 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7808 backend private_monitoring
7809 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007810 stats uri /admin?stats
7811 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007812
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007813 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007814
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007815
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007816stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7817 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7818 Access control for statistics
7819
7820 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7821 no | no | yes | yes
7822
7823 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7824 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7825 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7826 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7827 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7828 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7829
7830 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7831 instance.
7832
7833 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7834 about ACL usage.
7835
7836
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007837stats realm <realm>
7838 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007840 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007841 Arguments :
7842 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7843 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7844 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7845
7846 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7847 using a backslash ('\').
7848
7849 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7850 only related to authentication.
7851
7852 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7853 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7854 unobvious parameters.
7855
7856 Example :
7857 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7858 backend public_www
7859 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7860 stats enable
7861 stats hide-version
7862 stats scope .
7863 stats uri /admin?stats
7864 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7865 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7866 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7867
7868 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7869 backend private_monitoring
7870 stats enable
7871 stats uri /admin?stats
7872 stats refresh 5s
7873
7874 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7875
7876
7877stats refresh <delay>
7878 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007880 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007881 Arguments :
7882 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7883 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7884 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7885 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7886 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7887 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7888
7889 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7890 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7891 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7892 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7893
7894 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7895 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7896 unobvious parameters.
7897
7898 Example :
7899 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7900 backend public_www
7901 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7902 stats enable
7903 stats hide-version
7904 stats scope .
7905 stats uri /admin?stats
7906 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7907 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7908 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7909
7910 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7911 backend private_monitoring
7912 stats enable
7913 stats uri /admin?stats
7914 stats refresh 5s
7915
7916 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7917
7918
7919stats scope { <name> | "." }
7920 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007922 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007923 Arguments :
7924 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7925 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7926 section in which the statement appears.
7927
7928 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7929 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7930 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7931 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7932 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7933 exists.
7934
7935 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7936 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7937 unobvious parameters.
7938
7939 Example :
7940 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7941 backend public_www
7942 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7943 stats enable
7944 stats hide-version
7945 stats scope .
7946 stats uri /admin?stats
7947 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7948 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7949 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7950
7951 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7952 backend private_monitoring
7953 stats enable
7954 stats uri /admin?stats
7955 stats refresh 5s
7956
7957 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7958
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007959
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007960stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007961 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007963 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007964
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007965 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007966 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7967
7968 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7969 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7970
7971 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7972 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007973 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007974
7975 Example :
7976 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7977 backend private_monitoring
7978 stats enable
7979 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7980 stats uri /admin?stats
7981 stats refresh 5s
7982
7983 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7984 global section.
7985
7986
7987stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007988 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7990 yes | yes | yes | yes
7991 Arguments : none
7992
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007993 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007994 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7995 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7996 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7997 - IP (socket, server)
7998 - cookie (backend, server)
7999
8000 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8001 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008002 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008003
8004 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8005
8006
8007stats show-node [ <name> ]
8008 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008010 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008011 Arguments:
8012 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8013 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8014
8015 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8016 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008017 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008018
8019 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8020 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8021 unobvious parameters.
8022
8023 Example:
8024 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8025 backend private_monitoring
8026 stats enable
8027 stats show-node Europe-1
8028 stats uri /admin?stats
8029 stats refresh 5s
8030
8031 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8032 section.
8033
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008034
8035stats uri <prefix>
8036 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008038 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008039 Arguments :
8040 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8041 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8042 query string.
8043
8044 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8045 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8046 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8047 possible to reach it in the application.
8048
8049 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008050 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008051 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8052 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8053 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8054 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8055
8056 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8057 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8058 an address or a port to statistics only.
8059
8060 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8061 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8062 unobvious parameters.
8063
8064 Example :
8065 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8066 backend public_www
8067 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8068 stats enable
8069 stats hide-version
8070 stats scope .
8071 stats uri /admin?stats
8072 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8073 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8074 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8075
8076 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8077 backend private_monitoring
8078 stats enable
8079 stats uri /admin?stats
8080 stats refresh 5s
8081
8082 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8083
8084
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008085stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8086 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008088 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008089
8090 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008091 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008092 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8093 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8094 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8095
8096 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8097 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8098 the "stick-table" statement.
8099
8100 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8101 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8102 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8103 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8104 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8105
8106 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8107 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8108 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8109 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8110 transformation rules.
8111
8112 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8113 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8114 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8115 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8116 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8117 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8118 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8119
8120 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8121 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8122 ACL based conditions.
8123
8124 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8125 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8126 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8127 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8128
8129 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8130 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8131 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8132 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8133
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008134 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8135 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8136 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8137
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008138 Example :
8139 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8140 # last 30 minutes
8141 backend pop
8142 mode tcp
8143 balance roundrobin
8144 stick store-request src
8145 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8146 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8147 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8148
8149 backend smtp
8150 mode tcp
8151 balance roundrobin
8152 stick match src table pop
8153 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8154 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8155
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008156 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008157 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008158
8159
8160stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8161 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8163 no | no | yes | yes
8164
8165 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8166 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8167 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8168 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8169
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008170 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8171 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8172 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8173
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008174 Examples :
8175 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008176 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008177
8178 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8179 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8180 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8181
8182
8183 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8184 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8185 backend http
8186 mode http
8187 balance roundrobin
8188 stick on src table https
8189 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8190 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8191 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8192
8193 backend https
8194 mode tcp
8195 balance roundrobin
8196 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8197 stick on src
8198 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8199 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8200
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008201 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008202
8203
8204stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8205 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8207 no | no | yes | yes
8208
8209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008210 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008211 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8212 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8213 server is selected.
8214
8215 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8216 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8217 the "stick-table" statement.
8218
8219 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8220 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8221 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8222 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8223 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8224 address.
8225
8226 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8227 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8228 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8229 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8230 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8231 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8232 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8233 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8234 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8235 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8236
8237 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8238 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8239 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8240 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8241 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8242 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8243 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8244
8245 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8246 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8247 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8248 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8249
8250 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8251 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8252 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8253 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8254 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8255 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008256 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8257 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8258 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8259 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8260 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8261 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008262
8263 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8264 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8265 the request.
8266
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008267 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8268 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8269 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8270
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008271 Example :
8272 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8273 # last 30 minutes
8274 backend pop
8275 mode tcp
8276 balance roundrobin
8277 stick store-request src
8278 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8279 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8280 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8281
8282 backend smtp
8283 mode tcp
8284 balance roundrobin
8285 stick match src table pop
8286 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8287 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8288
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008289 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008290 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008291
8292
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008293stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008294 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8295 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008296 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008298 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008299
8300 Arguments :
8301 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8302 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8303 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8304 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8305
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008306 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8307 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8308 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8309 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8310
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008311 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8312 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8313 instance.
8314
8315 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8316 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8317 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8318 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8319 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8320 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008321 to 32 characters.
8322
8323 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8324 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8325 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008326 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008327 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8328 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008329
8330 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008331 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8332 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008333 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8334 increase.
8335
8336 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008337 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8338 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8339 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008340
8341 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8342 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8343 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8344 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8345 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8346 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8347 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8348 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8349 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8350 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8351 parameter (see below).
8352
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008353 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8354 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8355 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8356 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8357 soft restart.
8358
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008359 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8360 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008361
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008362 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8363 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8364 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8365 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8366 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008367 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008368 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8369 if not expiration delay is specified.
8370
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008371 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8372 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8373 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8374 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008375 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8376 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8377 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8378 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8379 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8380 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8381 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8382 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8383 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8384 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8385 types and their arguments.
8386
8387 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8388 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8389 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8390 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8391
8392 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8393 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8394 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8395 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8396
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008397 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8398 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8399 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8400 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8401 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8402 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8403
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008404 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8405 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8406 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8407 they were received.
8408
8409 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8410 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8411 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8412 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8413 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8414
8415 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8416 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8417 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8418 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8419 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8420
8421 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8422 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8423 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8424
8425 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8426 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8427 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8428 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8429 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8430
8431 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8432 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8433 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8434 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8435 the client side.
8436
8437 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8438 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8439 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8440 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8441 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8442 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8443 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8444
8445 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8446 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8447 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8448 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8449 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8450 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8451 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8452
8453 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8454 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8455 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8456 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8457 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8458 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8459
8460 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8461 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8462 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8463 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8464
8465 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8466 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8467 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8468 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8469 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8470 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8471 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8472 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8473 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8474 recommended for better fairness.
8475
8476 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8477 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8478 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8479 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8480
8481 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8482 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8483 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8484 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8485 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8486 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8487 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8488 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8489 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8490 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008491
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008492 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8493 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008494 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8495 reference it.
8496
8497 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8498 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008499 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8500 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8501 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008502
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008503 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8504 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8505 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8506 something that can be ignored.
8507
8508 Example:
8509 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8510 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8511 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8512 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8513
8514 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008515 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008516
8517
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008518stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008519 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8521 no | no | yes | yes
8522
8523 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008524 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008525 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8526 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8527 server is selected.
8528
8529 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8530 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8531 the "stick-table" statement.
8532
8533 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8534 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8535 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8536 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8537
8538 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8539 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8540 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8541 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8542 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8543 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008544 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008545 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8546 rules.
8547
8548 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8549 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8550 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8551 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8552 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8553 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8554 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8555
8556 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8557 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8558 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8559 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8560
8561 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8562 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8563 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8564 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8565 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8566 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008567 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8568 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8569 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8570 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8571 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8572 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8573 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8574 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8575 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008576
8577 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8578
8579 Example :
8580 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8581 backend https
8582 mode tcp
8583 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008584 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008585 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008586
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008587 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8588 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8589
8590 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8591 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8592 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8593
8594 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8595 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008596
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008597 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8598 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8599 # at offset 44.
8600
8601 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8602 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8603
8604 # Learn on response if server hello.
8605 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008606
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008607 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8608 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8609
8610 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8611 extraction.
8612
8613
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008614tcp-check connect [params*]
8615 Opens a new connection
8616 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8617 no | no | yes | yes
8618
8619 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8620 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8621 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8622
8623 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8624 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8625 of the sequence.
8626
8627 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8628 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8629 do.
8630
8631 Parameters :
8632 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8633 use the TCP connection.
8634
8635 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8636 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8637 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8638
8639 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8640
8641 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8642
8643 Examples:
8644 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8645 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8646 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8647 option tcp-check
8648 tcp-check connect
8649 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8650 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8651 tcp-check send \r\n
8652 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8653 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8654 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8655 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8656 tcp-check send \r\n
8657 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8658 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8659
8660 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8661 option tcp-check
8662 tcp-check connect port 110
8663 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8664 tcp-check connect port 143
8665 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8666 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8667
8668 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8669
8670
8671tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8672 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8674 no | no | yes | yes
8675
8676 Arguments :
8677 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8678 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8679 binary.
8680 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8681 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8682 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8683
8684 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8685 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8686 with the usual backslash ('\').
8687 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8688 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8689 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8690 used upper or lower case.
8691
8692
8693 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8694
8695 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8696 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8697 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8698 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8699 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8700 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8701 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8702 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8703
8704 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8705 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8706 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8707 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8708 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8709 expression.
8710
8711 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8712 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8713 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8714 this exact hexadecimal string.
8715 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8716
8717 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8718 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8719 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8720 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8721 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8722 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8723 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8724 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8725 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8726 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8727 the null character.
8728
8729 Examples :
8730 # perform a POP check
8731 option tcp-check
8732 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8733
8734 # perform an IMAP check
8735 option tcp-check
8736 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8737
8738 # look for the redis master server
8739 option tcp-check
8740 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008741 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008742 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8743 tcp-check expect string role:master
8744 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8745 tcp-check expect string +OK
8746
8747
8748 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8749 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8750
8751
8752tcp-check send <data>
8753 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8754 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8755 no | no | yes | yes
8756
8757 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8758 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8759
8760 Examples :
8761 # look for the redis master server
8762 option tcp-check
8763 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8764 tcp-check expect string role:master
8765
8766 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8767 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8768
8769
8770tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8771 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8772 tcp health check
8773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8774 no | no | yes | yes
8775
8776 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8777 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8778 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8779 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8780 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8781 hexadecimal string.
8782 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8783
8784 Examples :
8785 # redis check in binary
8786 option tcp-check
8787 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8788 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8789
8790
8791 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8792 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8793
8794
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008795tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8796 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8798 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008799 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008800 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8801 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008802
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008803 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008804
8805 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8806 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008807 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8808 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8809 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8810 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8811 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8812 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008813
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008814 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8815 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8816 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8817 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008818
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008819 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008820 - accept :
8821 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8822 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8823 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008824
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008825 - reject :
8826 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8827 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8828 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8829 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8830 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8831 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8832 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8833 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8834 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8835 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8836 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008837 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008838
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008839 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8840 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8841 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8842 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8843 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8844 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8845 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8846 hosts.
8847
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008848 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8849 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8850 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8851 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8852 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8853 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8854 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8855 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8856
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008857 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8858 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8859 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8860 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8861 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8862 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8863 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8864 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8865 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008866 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8867 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008868
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008869 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008870 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008871 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008872 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008873 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8874 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008875 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008876 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8877 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8878 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8879 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8880 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008881
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008882 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008883 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008884 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008885 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8886 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8887 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8888 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008889
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008890 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8891 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8892 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8893 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008895 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8896 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8897 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8898 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8899 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008900 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8901 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8902 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8903 layer7 information is extracted.
8904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008905 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8906 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8907 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8908 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8909 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008910
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008911 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8912 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8913 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8914 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8915
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008916 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8917 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8918 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8919 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8920 continues.
8921
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008922 - set-src <expr> :
8923 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8924 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8925 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8926 set-src"
8927
8928 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8929 followed by some converters.
8930
8931 Example:
8932
8933 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8934
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008935 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8936 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008937
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008938 - set-src-port <expr> :
8939 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8940 expression.
8941
8942 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8943 followed by some converters.
8944
8945 Example:
8946
8947 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8948
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008949 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8950 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8951 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008952
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008953 - set-dst <expr> :
8954 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8955 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8956 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8957 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8958 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8959
8960 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8961 followed by some converters.
8962
8963 Example:
8964
8965 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8966 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8967
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008968 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
8969 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
8970
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008971 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8972 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8973 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8974 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8975
8976
8977 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8978 followed by some converters.
8979
8980 Example:
8981
8982 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8983
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008984 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
8985 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
8986 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8987
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008988 - "silent-drop" :
8989 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8990 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8991 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8992 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8993 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8994 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8995 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8996 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8997 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8998 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8999 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9000 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9001 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9002 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9003 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9004 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9005
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009006 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9007 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9008 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009010 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9011 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9012 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009013
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009014 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009015 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009016 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009018 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9019 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9020 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009022 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009023 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9024 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009025
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009026 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9027
9028 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9029
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009030 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9031
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009032 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009033
9034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009035tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9036 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009038 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009040 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9041 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009042
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009043 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009045 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9046 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9047 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9048 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9049 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009050
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009051 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9052 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9053 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9054 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009055 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9056 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9057 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9058 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9059 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9060 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009061 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009062 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009064 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9065 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9066 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9067 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009068
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009069 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009070 - accept : the request is accepted
9071 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9072 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009073 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009074 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009075 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009076 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009077 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009078 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009079
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009080 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9081 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009082
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009083 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9084 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9085 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9086 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9087 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9088 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009090 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009091 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9092 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009094 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009095 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9096 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9097 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9098 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009099 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9100 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9101 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009102
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009103 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009104 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9105 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9106 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009107
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009108 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009109 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9110 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009111
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009112 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9113 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009114 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009115 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9116 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009117 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009118 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009119 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009120 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9121 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009122 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009123 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9124 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009125
9126 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9127 followed by some converters.
9128
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009129 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9130 <var-name>.
9131
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009132 Example:
9133
9134 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009135 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009136
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009137 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009138 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9139 # and reject everything else.
9140 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9141 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009142 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009143 tcp-request content reject
9144
9145 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009146 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9147 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9148 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009149 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009150
9151 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9152 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9153 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009154 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009155 tcp-request content reject
9156
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009157 Example:
9158 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9159 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009160 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009161
9162 Example:
9163 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9164 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009165 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009166
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009167 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9168 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9169
9170 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009171 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009172 # protecting all our sites
9173 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009174 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9175 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009176 ...
9177 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9178
9179 backend http_dynamic
9180 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009181 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009182 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009183 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9184 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9185 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009186 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009188 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009189
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009190 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9191 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009192
9193
9194tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9195 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009197 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009198 Arguments :
9199 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9200 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9201 as explained at the top of this document.
9202
9203 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9204 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9205 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9206 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9207 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9208
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009209 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9210 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9211 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9212 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9213
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009214 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9215 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009216 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009217 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009218 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9219 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9220 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9221 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009222
9223 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9224 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9225 it pass through unaffected.
9226
9227 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9228 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9229 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009230 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009231 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9232 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009233 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9234 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9235 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009236
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009237 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009238 "timeout client".
9239
9240
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009241tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9242 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9244 no | no | yes | yes
9245 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009246 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9247 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009248
9249 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9250
9251 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9252 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9253 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009254 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9255 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009256
9257 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9258
9259 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9260 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9261 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9262 inserted.
9263
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009264 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009265 - accept :
9266 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9267 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9268 the rules evaluation.
9269
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009270 - close :
9271 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9272 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9273 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9274 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9275 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9276 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009277 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009278 protocols.
9279
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009280 - reject :
9281 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9282 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009283 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009284
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009285 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9286 Sets a variable.
9287
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009288 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9289 Unsets a variable.
9290
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009291 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9292 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9293 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9294 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9295
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009296 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9297 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9298 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9299 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9300 continues.
9301
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009302 - "silent-drop" :
9303 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9304 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9305 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9306 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9307 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9308 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9309 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9310 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9311 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9312 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9313 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9314 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9315 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9316 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9317 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9318 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9319
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009320 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9321 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9322 for changing the default action to a reject.
9323
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009324 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9325 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9326 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9327 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009328 period.
9329
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009330 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9331 declared inline.
9332
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009333 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9334 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009335 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009336 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9337 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009338 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009339 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009340 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009341 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9342 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009343 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009344 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9345 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009346
9347 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9348 followed by some converters.
9349
9350 Example:
9351
9352 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9353
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009354 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9355 <var-name>.
9356
9357 Example:
9358
9359 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9360
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009361 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9362
9363 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9364
9365
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009366tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9367 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9369 no | yes | yes | no
9370 Arguments :
9371 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9372 below.
9373
9374 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9375
9376 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9377 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9378 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9379 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9380 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9381 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9382 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9383 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9384 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9385 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9386 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9387 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9388 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9389 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9390 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9391 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9392 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9393 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9394 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9395 instead.
9396
9397 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9398 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9399 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9400 rules which may be inserted.
9401
9402 Several types of actions are supported :
9403 - accept : the request is accepted
9404 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9405 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9406 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9407 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9408 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009409 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009410 - silent-drop
9411
9412 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9413 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9414 sections for a complete description.
9415
9416 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9417 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9418 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9419
9420 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9421 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9422 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9423 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9424 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9425
9426 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9427 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9428
9429 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9430 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9431 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9432
9433 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9434 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9435 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9436
9437 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9438 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9439 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9440
9441 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9442 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9443 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9444
9445 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9446
9447 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9448
9449
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009450tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9451 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9453 no | no | yes | yes
9454 Arguments :
9455 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9456 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9457 as explained at the top of this document.
9458
9459 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9460
9461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009462timeout check <timeout>
9463 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9464 established.
9465
9466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9467 yes | no | yes | yes
9468 Arguments:
9469 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9470 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9471 as explained at the top of this document.
9472
9473 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9474 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9475 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9476 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009477 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9478 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9479 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009480
9481 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9482 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9483
9484 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9485 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009486 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009487
9488 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9489 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9490 forget about it.
9491
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009492 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9493 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009494
9495
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009496timeout client <timeout>
9497timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9498 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9500 yes | yes | yes | no
9501 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009502 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009503 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9504 as explained at the top of this document.
9505
9506 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9507 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9508 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009509 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9510 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9511 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9512 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009513 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9514 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9515 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009516 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009517 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009518 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9519 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009520 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9521 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009522
9523 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9524 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9525 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9526 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9527 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9528 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9529
9530 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9531 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9532 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9533
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009534 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9535 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009536
9537
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009538timeout client-fin <timeout>
9539 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9541 yes | yes | yes | no
9542 Arguments :
9543 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9544 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9545 as explained at the top of this document.
9546
9547 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9548 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9549 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9550 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9551 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9552 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9553 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9554 down in one direction.
9555
9556 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9557 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9558 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9559
9560 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9561
9562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009563timeout connect <timeout>
9564timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9565 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9567 yes | no | yes | yes
9568 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009569 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009570 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9571 as explained at the top of this document.
9572
9573 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009574 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009575 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009576 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009577 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9578 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009579
9580 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9581 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9582 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9583 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9584 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9585 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9586
9587 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9588 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9589 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9590
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009591 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9592 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009593
9594
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009595timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9596 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9598 yes | yes | yes | yes
9599 Arguments :
9600 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9601 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9602 as explained at the top of this document.
9603
9604 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9605 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9606 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9607 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9608 once the request has started to present itself.
9609
9610 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9611 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9612 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9613 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9614 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9615
9616 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9617 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9618 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9619 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9620
9621 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9622 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9623 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9624 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9625 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009626 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009627
9628 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9629 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9630 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9631 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9632
9633 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9634
9635
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009636timeout http-request <timeout>
9637 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009639 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009640 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009641 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009642 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9643 as explained at the top of this document.
9644
9645 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9646 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9647 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9648 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9649 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9650 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9651 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009652 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9653 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9654 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9655 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9656 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009657 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9658 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009659
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009660 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9661 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9662 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9663 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9664 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009665 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009666
9667 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9668 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9669 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9670 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9671 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9672
9673 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009674 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9675 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9676 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009677
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009678 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009679 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009680
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009681
9682timeout queue <timeout>
9683 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9685 yes | no | yes | yes
9686 Arguments :
9687 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9688 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9689 as explained at the top of this document.
9690
9691 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9692 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9693 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9694 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9695 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9696
9697 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9698 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9699 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9700 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9701
9702 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9703
9704
9705timeout server <timeout>
9706timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9707 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9709 yes | no | yes | yes
9710 Arguments :
9711 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9712 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9713 as explained at the top of this document.
9714
9715 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9716 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9717 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9718 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9719 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9720 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9721 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9722
9723 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9724 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9725 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9726 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9727 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009728 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009729 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009730 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9731 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9732 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9733 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009734
9735 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9736 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9737 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9738 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9739 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9740 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9741
9742 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9743 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9744 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9745
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009746 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009747
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009748
9749timeout server-fin <timeout>
9750 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9752 yes | no | yes | yes
9753 Arguments :
9754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9756 as explained at the top of this document.
9757
9758 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9759 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9760 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9761 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9762 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9763 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9764 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9765 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9766 situations, it should not be needed.
9767
9768 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9769 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9770 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9771
9772 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9773
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009774
9775timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009776 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9778 yes | yes | yes | yes
9779 Arguments :
9780 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9781 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9782 as explained at the top of this document.
9783
9784 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9785 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9786 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9787
9788 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9789 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9790 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9791 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009792 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009793
9794 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9795
9796
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009797timeout tunnel <timeout>
9798 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9800 yes | no | yes | yes
9801 Arguments :
9802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9804 as explained at the top of this document.
9805
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009806 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009807 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9808 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9809 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9810 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9811 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9812 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9813 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9814 specified.
9815
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009816 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9817 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9818 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9819 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9820 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9821 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9822 state.
9823
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009824 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9825 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9826 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9827 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9828 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9829
9830 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9831 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9832 forget about it.
9833
9834 Example :
9835 defaults http
9836 option http-server-close
9837 timeout connect 5s
9838 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009839 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009840 timeout server 30s
9841 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9842
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009843 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009844
9845
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009846transparent (deprecated)
9847 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009849 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009850 Arguments : none
9851
9852 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9853 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9854 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9855 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9856 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9857 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9858 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9859 appropriate server.
9860
9861 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9862
9863 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9864 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9865
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009866 See also: "option transparent"
9867
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009868unique-id-format <string>
9869 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9871 yes | yes | yes | no
9872 Arguments :
9873 <string> is a log-format string.
9874
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009875 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9876 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9877 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9878 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009879
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009880 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9881 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9882 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9883 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9884 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9885 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9886 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9887 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009888
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009889 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9890 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009891
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009892 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009893
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009894 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009895
9896 will generate:
9897
9898 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9899
9900 See also: "unique-id-header"
9901
9902unique-id-header <name>
9903 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9905 yes | yes | yes | no
9906 Arguments :
9907 <name> is the name of the header.
9908
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009909 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9910 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009911
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009912 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009913
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009914 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009915 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9916
9917 will generate:
9918
9919 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9920
9921 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009922
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009923use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009924 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9926 no | yes | yes | no
9927 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009928 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9929 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009930
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009931 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9932 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009933
9934 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9935 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9936 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009937 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9938 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9939 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9940 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009941
9942 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9943 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9944 assign the backend.
9945
9946 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9947 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9948 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9949 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9950 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9951 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9952
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009953 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009954 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009955 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9956 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9957 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9958
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009959 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9960 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9961 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9962 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9963 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9964 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9965 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9966 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9967 cannot be forced from the request.
9968
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009969 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009970 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9971 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9972
9973 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9974 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009975
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009976
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009977use-server <server> if <condition>
9978use-server <server> unless <condition>
9979 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9981 no | no | yes | yes
9982 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009983 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009984
9985 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9986
9987 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9988 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9989 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9990
9991 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9992 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9993 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9994 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9995 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9996 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9997 matches will assign the server.
9998
9999 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10000 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10001 with the next rules until one matches.
10002
10003 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10004 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10005 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10006 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10007
10008 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10009 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10010 stripped.
10011
10012 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10013 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10014 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10015 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10016
10017 Example :
10018 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10019 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10020 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10021 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10022 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10023 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
10024 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
10025 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10026 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10027
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010028 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010029
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010030
100315. Bind and Server options
10032--------------------------
10033
10034The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10035depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10036settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10037written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10038described in this section.
10039
10040
100415.1. Bind options
10042-----------------
10043
10044The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10045as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10046no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10047parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10048while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10049provided immediately after the setting name.
10050
10051The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10052
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010053accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10054 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10055 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10056 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10057 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10058 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10059 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10060 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10061 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10062 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010063 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10064 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10065 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010066
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010067accept-proxy
10068 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010069 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10070 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010071 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10072 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10073 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10074 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10075 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10076 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10077 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010078 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10079 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010080
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010081alpn <protocols>
10082 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10083 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10084 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10085 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10086 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10087 initial NPN extension.
10088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010089backlog <backlog>
10090 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10091 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10092
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010093ecdhe <named curve>
10094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010095 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10096 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010097
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010098ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10100 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10101 client's certificate.
10102
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010103ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10105 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10106 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10107 error is ignored.
10108
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010109ca-sign-file <cafile>
10110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10111 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10112 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10113 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10114 'generate-certificates' for details.
10115
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010116ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10118 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10119 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10120 'generate-certificates' for details.
10121
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010122ciphers <ciphers>
10123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10124 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010125 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010126 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10127 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10128
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010129crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10131 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10132 to verify client's certificate.
10133
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010134crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10136 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10137 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10138 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10139 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10140 file.
10141
10142 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10143 are loaded.
10144
10145 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010146 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010147 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10148 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10149 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10150 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10151 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10152 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10153 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010154
10155 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10156 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10157 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10158 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010159 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10160 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010161
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010162 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010163
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010164 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10165 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010166 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010167 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10168 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10169 clients).
10170
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010171 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10172 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10173 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10174 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10175 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10176 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10177 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10178 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10179 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10180 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10181 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10182 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10183 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10184
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010185 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10186 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10187 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10188 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10189 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10190
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010191 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10192 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10193 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10194 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010195
10196 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10197 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10198 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10199 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10200 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10201 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10202 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10203 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10204 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10205
10206 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10207
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010208 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010209 a cert bundle.
10210
10211 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10212 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10213 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10214 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10215 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10216 provide multi-cert support.
10217
10218 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10219
10220 Filename | CN | SAN
10221 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10222 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010223 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010224 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10225 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10226
10227 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10228 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10229 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10230 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
10231 suites.
10232
10233 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10234 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10235
10236 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10237 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10238 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10239
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010240crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10242 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010243 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010244 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010245
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010246crt-list <file>
10247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010248 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
10249 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010250
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010251 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010252
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010253 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10254 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10255 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10256 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10257 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10258 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10259 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10260 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010261
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010262 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010263 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
10264 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010265
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010266defer-accept
10267 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10268 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10269 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10270 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10271 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10272 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10273 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10274 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10275 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10276 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10277 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10278
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010279force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010280 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010281 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010282 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10283 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010284
10285force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010286 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010287 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10288 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010289
10290force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010291 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010292 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10293 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010294
10295force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010296 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010297 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10298 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010299
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010300generate-certificates
10301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10302 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10303 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10304 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10305 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10306 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10307 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10308 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10309 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10310 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10311 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10312
10313 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10314 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10315 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10316 certificate is used many times.
10317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010318gid <gid>
10319 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10320 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10321 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10322 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10323 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10324
10325group <group>
10326 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10327 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10328 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10329 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10330 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10331
10332id <id>
10333 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10334 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10335 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10336 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10337
10338interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010339 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10340 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10341 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10342 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10343 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10344 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10345 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010346
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010347level <level>
10348 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10349 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10350 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10351 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10352 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10353 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10354 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10355 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10356 counters).
10357 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10358 all counters).
10359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010360maxconn <maxconn>
10361 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10362 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10363 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10364 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10365 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10366 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10367 eat all memory.
10368
10369mode <mode>
10370 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10371 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10372 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10373 UNIX sockets.
10374
10375mss <maxseg>
10376 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10377 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10378 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10379 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10380 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10381 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10382 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10383 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10384 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10385 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10386 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10387
10388name <name>
10389 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10390 page.
10391
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010392namespace <name>
10393 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10394 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10395 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10396 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10397
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010398nice <nice>
10399 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10400 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10401 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10402 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10403 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10404 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10405 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10406 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10407 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10408 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10409 one for an RDP socket.
10410
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010411no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010412 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010413 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010414 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010415 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10416 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010417 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010418
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010419no-tls-tickets
10420 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10421 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10422 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010423 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10424 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010425
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010426no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010427 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010428 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010429 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010430 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10431 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10432 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010433
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010434no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010435 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010436 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010437 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010438 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10439 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10440 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010441
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010442no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010444 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010445 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010446 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10447 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10448 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010449
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010450npn <protocols>
10451 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10452 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10453 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10454 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010455 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10456 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010457
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010458process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10459 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10460 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10461 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10462 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10463 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10464 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10465 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010466 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10467 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10468 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10469 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10470 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10471 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10472 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010473
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010474ssl
10475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010476 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010477 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10478 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10479 to deciphered contents.
10480
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010481strict-sni
10482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10483 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10484 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10485 See the "crt" option for more information.
10486
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010487tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010488 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010489 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10490 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010491 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010492 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10493 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10494 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10495 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10496 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10497 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10498 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10499
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010500tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010501 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010502 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10503 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10504 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10505 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10506 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10507 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10508 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010509 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10510 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10511 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010512
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010513tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10514 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10515 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10516 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10517 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10518 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10519 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10520 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10521 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10522 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10523 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10524
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010525transparent
10526 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10527 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10528 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10529 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10530 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10531 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10532 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10533 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10534 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10535 so check for support with your vendor.
10536
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010537v4v6
10538 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10539 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10540 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10541 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010542 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010543
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010544v6only
10545 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10546 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10547 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010548 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10549 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010550
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010551uid <uid>
10552 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10553 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10554 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10555 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10556 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10557
10558user <user>
10559 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10560 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10561 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10562 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10563 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10564
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010565verify [none|optional|required]
10566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10567 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10568 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10569 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10570 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010571 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10572 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10573 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10574 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010575
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200105765.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010577------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010579The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10580which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10581arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10582settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10583after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10584Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10585address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010587 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010588 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010590The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010591
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010592addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010593 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010594 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10595 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10596 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10597 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10598 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010600 Supported in default-server: No
10601
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010602agent-check
10603 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010604 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10605 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10606 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10607 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010608
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010609 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010610 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010611 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10612 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10613 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010614
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010615 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10616 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10617 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10618 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10619 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10620
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010621 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10622 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010623
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010624 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10625 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10626 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010627
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010628 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10629 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10630 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010631
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010632 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10633 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10634 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10635 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10636 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10637 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10638 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010639
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010640 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10641 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010642
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010643 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10644 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10645 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10646 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10647 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10648 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10649 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10650 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10651 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010652
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010653 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10654 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010655 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10656 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10657 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010658 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010659
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010660 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10661 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010662
10663 Supported in default-server: No
10664
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010665agent-send <string>
10666 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10667 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10668 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10669 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10670 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10671
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010672agent-inter <delay>
10673 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10674 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10675
10676 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10677 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10678 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10679 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10680 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10681 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10682 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10683 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10684 of backends use the same servers.
10685
10686 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10687
10688 Supported in default-server: Yes
10689
10690agent-port <port>
10691 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10692
10693 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10694
10695 Supported in default-server: Yes
10696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010697backup
10698 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10699 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10700 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10701 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10702 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10703 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010705 Supported in default-server: No
10706
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010707ca-file <cafile>
10708 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10709 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10710 server's certificate.
10711
10712 Supported in default-server: No
10713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010714check
10715 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010716 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10717 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10718 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10719 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10720 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10721 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10722 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010723 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10724 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10725 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010727 Supported in default-server: No
10728
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010729check-send-proxy
10730 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10731 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10732 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10733 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10734 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10735 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10736 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10737
10738 Supported in default-server: No
10739
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010740check-ssl
10741 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10742 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10743 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10744 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010745 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010746 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10747 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10748 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10749 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10750
10751 Supported in default-server: No
10752
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010753ciphers <ciphers>
10754 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010755 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010756 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10757 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10758 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10759 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10760 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10761 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10762
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010763 Supported in default-server: No
10764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010765cookie <value>
10766 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10767 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10768 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10769 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10770 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10771 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10772 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010774 Supported in default-server: No
10775
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010776crl-file <crlfile>
10777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10778 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10779 to verify server's certificate.
10780
10781 Supported in default-server: No
10782
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010783crt <cert>
10784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10785 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10786 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10787 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10788 certificate request.
10789
10790 Supported in default-server: No
10791
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010792disabled
10793 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10794 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10795 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10796 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10797 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10798
10799 Supported in default-server: No
10800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010801error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010802 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10803 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10804 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010806 Supported in default-server: Yes
10807
10808 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010810fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010811 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10812 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10813 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010815 Supported in default-server: Yes
10816
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010817force-sslv3
10818 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10819 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010820 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10821 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010822
10823 Supported in default-server: No
10824
10825force-tlsv10
10826 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010827 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10828 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010829
10830 Supported in default-server: No
10831
10832force-tlsv11
10833 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010834 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10835 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010836
10837 Supported in default-server: No
10838
10839force-tlsv12
10840 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010841 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10842 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010843
10844 Supported in default-server: No
10845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010846id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010847 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10848 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10849 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010851 Supported in default-server: No
10852
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010853init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10854 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10855 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10856 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10857 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10858 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10859 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10860 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10861 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10862 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10863 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10864 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10865 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10866 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10867 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10868 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10869 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10870 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10871 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10872 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10873 historic behaviour.
10874
10875 Example:
10876 defaults
10877 # never fail on address resolution
10878 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10879
10880 Supported in default-server: Yes
10881
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010882inter <delay>
10883fastinter <delay>
10884downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010885 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10886 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10887 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10888 between checks depending on the server state :
10889
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010890 Server state | Interval used
10891 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10892 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10893 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10894 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10895 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10896 or yet unchecked. |
10897 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10898 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10899 | "inter" otherwise.
10900 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010902 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10903 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10904 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10905 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010906 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10907 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10908 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10909 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10910 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010912 Supported in default-server: Yes
10913
10914maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010915 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10916 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10917 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10918 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10919 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10920 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10921 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10922 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010924 Supported in default-server: Yes
10925
10926maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010927 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10928 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10929 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10930 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10931 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10932 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10933 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010935 Supported in default-server: Yes
10936
10937minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010938 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10939 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10940 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10941 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10942 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10943 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010944 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010945 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010947 Supported in default-server: Yes
10948
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010949namespace <name>
10950 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10951 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10952 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10953 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10954
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010955no-ssl-reuse
10956 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10957 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10958 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10959 and for paranoid users.
10960
10961 Supported in default-server: No
10962
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010963no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010964 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10965 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010966 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010967
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010968 Supported in default-server: No
10969
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010970no-tls-tickets
10971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10972 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10973 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010974 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10975 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010976
10977 Supported in default-server: No
10978
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010979no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010980 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010981 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10982 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010983 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10984 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10985 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010986
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010987 Supported in default-server: No
10988
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010989no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010990 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010991 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10992 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010993 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10994 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10995 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010996
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010997 Supported in default-server: No
10998
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010999no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011000 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011001 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11002 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011003 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11004 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11005 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011006
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011007 Supported in default-server: No
11008
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011009non-stick
11010 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11011 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11012 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11013
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011014 Supported in default-server: No
11015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011016observe <mode>
11017 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11018 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11019 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11020 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11021 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11022 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011023 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011025 Supported in default-server: No
11026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011027 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011029on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011030 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11031 Currently, four modes are available:
11032 - fastinter: force fastinter
11033 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11034 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11035 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11036 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011038 Supported in default-server: Yes
11039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011040 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11041
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011042on-marked-down <action>
11043 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11044 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011045 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11046 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11047 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11048 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11049 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11050 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11051 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11052 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011053
11054 Actions are disabled by default
11055
11056 Supported in default-server: Yes
11057
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011058on-marked-up <action>
11059 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11060 Currently one action is available:
11061 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11062 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11063 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11064 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11065 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11066 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11067 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11068 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11069
11070 Actions are disabled by default
11071
11072 Supported in default-server: Yes
11073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011074port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011075 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11076 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11077 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11078 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11079 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11080 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011082 Supported in default-server: Yes
11083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011084redir <prefix>
11085 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11086 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11087 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11088 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11089 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11090 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11091 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11092 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011093 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011094 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11095 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11096 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11097 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11098 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11099
11100 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011102 Supported in default-server: No
11103
11104rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011105 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11106 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11107 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011109 Supported in default-server: Yes
11110
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011111resolve-prefer <family>
11112 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11113 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11114 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11115 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11116
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011117 Default value: ipv6
11118
11119 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011120
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011121 Example:
11122
11123 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011124
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011125resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11126 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11127 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011128 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011129 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11130 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11131 configured network, another address is selected.
11132
11133 Supported in default-server: Yes
11134
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011135 Example:
11136
11137 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011138
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011139resolvers <id>
11140 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11141 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011142 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11143 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11144 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11145 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011146
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011147 Supported in default-server: No
11148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011149 Example:
11150
11151 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011152
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011153 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011154
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011155send-proxy
11156 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11157 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11158 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11159 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011160 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11161 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11162 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11163 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11164 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11165 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11166 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11167 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11168 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11169 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
11170 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
11171 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011172
11173 Supported in default-server: No
11174
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011175send-proxy-v2
11176 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11177 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11178 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11179 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11180 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
11181 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
11182 option of the "bind" keyword.
11183
11184 Supported in default-server: No
11185
11186send-proxy-v2-ssl
11187 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11188 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11189 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11190 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11191 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11192 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11193 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11194 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11195
11196 Supported in default-server: No
11197
11198send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11199 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11200 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11201 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11202 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11203 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11204 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11205 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11206 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11207 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11208
11209 Supported in default-server: No
11210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011211slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011212 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11213 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11214 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11215 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11216 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11217 parameters :
11218
11219 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11220 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11221
11222 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11223 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11224 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11225 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11226
11227 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11228 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11229 seen as failed.
11230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011231 Supported in default-server: Yes
11232
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011233sni <expression>
11234 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11235 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11236 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11237 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11238 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11239
11240 Supported in default-server: no
11241
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011242source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011243source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011244source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011245 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11246 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11247 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11248 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11249
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011250 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11251 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11252 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11253 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11254 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11255 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11256 server.
11257
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011258 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11259 specifying the source address without port(s).
11260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011261 Supported in default-server: No
11262
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011263ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011264 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11265 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11266 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11267 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11268 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11269 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011270 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011271
11272 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011273
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011274tcp-ut <delay>
11275 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11276 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11277 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011278 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011279 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11280 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11281 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11282 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11283 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11284 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11285 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11286 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11287 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011289track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011290 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11291 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11292 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11293 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011294 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011296 Supported in default-server: No
11297
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011298verify [none|required]
11299 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011300 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11301 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11302 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11303 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011304 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11305 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11306 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011307
11308 Supported in default-server: No
11309
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011310verifyhost <hostname>
11311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11312 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11313 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11314 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11315 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11316 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11317
11318 Supported in default-server: No
11319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011320weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011321 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11322 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11323 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011324 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11325 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11326 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11327 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11328 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11329 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011331 Supported in default-server: Yes
11332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011333
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11335-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011336
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011337HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11338using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11339configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011340This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11341can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11342workload.
11343This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11344resolution at run time.
11345Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11346carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11347
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011348Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11349health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11350
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011351
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113525.3.1. Global overview
11353----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011354
11355As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11356different steps of the process life:
11357
11358 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11359 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11360 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11361
11362 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11363 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11364 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11365
11366A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11367 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11368 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11369 resolution to know this new IP.
11370
11371A few things important to notice:
11372 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11373 first valid response.
11374
11375 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11376 servers return an error.
11377
11378
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113795.3.2. The resolvers section
11380----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011381
11382This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11383HAProxy.
11384There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11385many name servers.
11386
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011387When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11388uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11389is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11390answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11391
11392When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11393used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11394
11395Two types of behavior can be applied:
11396 1. stop DNS resolution
11397 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11398 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11399 1. ANY query type
11400 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11401 server's parameter
11402 3. remaining family type
11403
11404HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11405 - invalid DNS response packet
11406 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11407 - NX domain
11408 - Query refused by server
11409 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11410
11411HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11412 - no Answer records in the response
11413 - DNS response truncated
11414 - Error in DNS response
11415 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11416 - name server timeout
11417
11418For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11419 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11420 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11421 applied;
11422 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11423 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11424 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11425 stops resolution.
11426
11427
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011428resolvers <resolvers id>
11429 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11430
11431A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11432
11433nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11434 DNS server description:
11435 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11436 <ip> : IP address of the server
11437 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11438
11439hold <status> <period>
11440 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11441 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011442 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11443 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011444 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11445 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11446 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11447
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011448 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011449
11450 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11451 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11452 the healch check.
11453
11454resolve_retries <nb>
11455 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11456 giving up.
11457 Default value: 3
11458
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011459 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11460 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11461 type.
11462
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011463timeout <event> <time>
11464 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11465 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11466 events available are:
11467 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11468 been received.
11469 Default value: 1s
11470 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11471 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11472
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011473 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011474
11475 resolvers mydns
11476 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11477 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11478 resolve_retries 3
11479 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011480 hold other 30s
11481 hold refused 30s
11482 hold nx 30s
11483 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011484 hold valid 10s
11485
11486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114876. HTTP header manipulation
11488---------------------------
11489
11490In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11491response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11492request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11493which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011494against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011495
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011496If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11497to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11498but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11499HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11500stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11501because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11502a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11503still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011505This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11506in section 4.2 :
11507
11508 - reqadd <string>
11509 - reqallow <search>
11510 - reqiallow <search>
11511 - reqdel <search>
11512 - reqidel <search>
11513 - reqdeny <search>
11514 - reqideny <search>
11515 - reqpass <search>
11516 - reqipass <search>
11517 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11518 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11519 - reqtarpit <search>
11520 - reqitarpit <search>
11521 - rspadd <string>
11522 - rspdel <search>
11523 - rspidel <search>
11524 - rspdeny <search>
11525 - rspideny <search>
11526 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11527 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11528
11529With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11530is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11531parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11532prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11533Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11534
11535 \t for a tab
11536 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11537 \n for a new line (LF)
11538 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11539 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11540 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11541 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11542 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11543
11544The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11545portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11546above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11547regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
115489 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11549is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11550
11551The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11552after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11553
11554Notes related to these keywords :
11555---------------------------------
11556 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11557 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11558 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11559
11560 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11561 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11562 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11563
11564 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11565 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11566 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11567 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11568 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11569
11570 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11571 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11572 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11573 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11574 useless headers before adding new ones.
11575
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011576 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011577 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11578
11579 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11580 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11581 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11582
11583 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11584 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011585 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011586
11587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115887. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11589----------------------------------
11590
11591Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11592client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11593The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11594these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11595but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11596data called patterns.
11597
11598
115997.1. ACL basics
11600---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011601
11602The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11603content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11604from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11605simple :
11606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011607 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011608 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011609 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11610 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011612The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11613adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011614
11615In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011618
11619This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11620Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11621and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011622an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11623conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11624as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11625are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011626
11627ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11628'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11629which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11630
11631There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11632performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011634The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11635specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11636this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011637methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11638ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011639
11640Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11641 - boolean
11642 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11643 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11644 - string
11645 - data block
11646
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011647Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11648converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11649would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11650The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11651which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11652
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011653Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11654keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11655fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11656which are summarized in the table below :
11657
11658 +---------------------+-----------------+
11659 | Sample or converter | Default |
11660 | output type | matching method |
11661 +---------------------+-----------------+
11662 | boolean | bool |
11663 +---------------------+-----------------+
11664 | integer | int |
11665 +---------------------+-----------------+
11666 | ip | ip |
11667 +---------------------+-----------------+
11668 | string | str |
11669 +---------------------+-----------------+
11670 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11671 +---------------------+-----------------+
11672
11673Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11674matching method, see below.
11675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011676The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11677 - boolean
11678 - integer or integer range
11679 - IP address / network
11680 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11681 - regular expression
11682 - hex block
11683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011684The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11685
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011686 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11687 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011688 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011689 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011690 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011691 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011692 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011694The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11695read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11696if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11697lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11698will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11699beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11700a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11701lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11702exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11703
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011704The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11705parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11706ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11707a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11708check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11709
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011710The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11711socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11712file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011714Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11715loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11716
11717 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11718
11719In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11720the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11721case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11722as well.
11723
11724The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11725sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11726do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11727methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11728is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11729obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11730followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11731default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11732that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11733string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11734
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011735The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11736By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11737string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11738resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11739server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11740waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11741flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11742function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011744There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11745sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11746be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011747
11748 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11749 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011750 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11751 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11752 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11753 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011754
11755 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11756 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011757 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011758
11759 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011760 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011761
11762 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011763 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011764
11765 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11766 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11767
11768 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11769 binary or string samples.
11770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011771 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11772 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011774 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11775 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11776 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011778 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11779 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011781 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11782 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011784 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11785 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011787 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11788 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011789 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11792 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11793 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011794
11795For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11796request, it is possible to do :
11797
11798 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11799
11800In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11801buffer, one would use the following acl :
11802
11803 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11804
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011805On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11806possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11807
11808 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011810All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11811criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11812method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11813to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11814criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11815the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011818the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11819For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011821 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11822 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11823 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11824 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011825
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011826
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011827The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11828types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11829combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11830brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11831default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833 +-------------------------------------------------+
11834 | Input sample type |
11835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011836 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11838 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11839 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011840 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011841 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011842 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011843 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011844 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011846 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011848 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011849 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011850 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011851 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011852 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011853 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011854 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011855 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011856 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011857 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011858 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011859 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011860 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011861 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11862 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11863 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011864
11865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118667.1.1. Matching booleans
11867------------------------
11868
11869In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11870Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11871When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11872that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11873
11874Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11875return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11876"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11877
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118797.1.2. Matching integers
11880------------------------
11881
11882Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11883enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11884to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11885
11886Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11887matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11888lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011889
11890For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11891unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11892representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11893
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011894As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11895two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11896instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11897ranges and operators.
11898
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011899For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011900operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11901Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11902of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011903
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011904Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011905
11906 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11907 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11908 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11909 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11910 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011912For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011913
11914 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11915
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011916This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11917
11918 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11919
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119217.1.3. Matching strings
11922-----------------------
11923
11924String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11925different forms :
11926
11927 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11928 patterns ;
11929
11930 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11931 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11932
11933 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11934 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11935
11936 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11937 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11938
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011939 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011940 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11941 matches.
11942
11943 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11944 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11945 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011946
11947String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11948exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11949characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11950string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11951to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011952before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011953
11954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119557.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11956---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011957
11958Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11959they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11960possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11961passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11962the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011963the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11964match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011965
11966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119677.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11968-------------------------------------
11969
11970It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11971not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11972a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11973to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11974digits may be used upper or lower case.
11975
11976Example :
11977 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11978 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11979
11980
119817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11982---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011983
11984IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11985netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11986within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011987host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011988difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11989at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11990does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11991parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011992
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011993The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11994abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11995
11996 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11997 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11998 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11999 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12000 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12001 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12002 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12003 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12004
12005Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12006192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12007
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012008IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12009Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12010trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12011IPv6 patterns.
12012
12013HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12014following situations :
12015 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12016 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12017 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12018 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12019 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12020 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12021 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12022 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12023 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12024 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012026
120277.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12028----------------------------------
12029
12030Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12031combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12032
12033 - AND (implicit)
12034 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12035 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012037A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012039 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012041Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12042indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012044For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12045"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12046requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12047is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12048
12049 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12050 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12051 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12052 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
12053
12054To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12055and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12056
12057 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12058 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12059 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12060 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12061
12062 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12063 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12064 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12065 use_backend www if host_www
12066
12067It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12068expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12069be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12070the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12071
12072 The following rule :
12073
12074 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12075 block if METH_POST missing_cl
12076
12077 Can also be written that way :
12078
12079 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
12080
12081It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12082to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12083simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12084sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12085good use is the following :
12086
12087 With named ACLs :
12088
12089 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12090 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12091 monitor fail if site_dead
12092
12093 With anonymous ACLs :
12094
12095 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12096
12097See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
12098
12099
121007.3. Fetching samples
12101---------------------
12102
12103Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12104against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12105sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12106ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12107of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12108available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12109
12110This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12111Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12112compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12113deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12114
12115The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12116matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12117method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12118indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12119
12120As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12121when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12122mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12123the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12124ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12125
12126Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12127multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12128when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12129incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12130are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12131is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12132all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12133
12134Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12135 - name
12136 - name(arg1)
12137 - name(arg1,arg2)
12138
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012139
121407.3.1. Converters
12141-----------------
12142
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012143Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12144of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12145is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12146was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12147has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12148unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12149
12150These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12151sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12152the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12153support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012154
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012155A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12156support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12157supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12158(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12159bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012161The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012162
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001216351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12164 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12165 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12166 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12167 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12168 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12169
12170 Example :
12171 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12172 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12173 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12174 frontend http-in
12175 bind *:8081
12176 default_backend servers
12177 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12178 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12179
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012180add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012181 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012182 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012183 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12184 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012185 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012186 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12187 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12188 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12189 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12190 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012191 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012192
12193and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012194 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012195 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012196 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12197 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012198 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012199 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12200 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12201 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12202 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12203 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012204 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012205
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012206base64
12207 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12208 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12209 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12210
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012211bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012212 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012213 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12214 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12215 presence of a flag).
12216
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012217bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12218 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12219 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012220 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012221
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012222cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012223 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12224 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012225
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012226crc32([<avalanche>])
12227 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12228 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12229 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12230 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12231 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12232 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12233 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12234 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12235 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12236 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12237 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12238
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012239da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012240 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12241 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12242 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12243 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012244 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012245 configuration language.
12246
12247 Example:
12248 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012249 bind *:8881
12250 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012251 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012252
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012253debug
12254 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12255 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12256 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12257
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012258div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012259 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12260 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012261 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012262 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12263 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012264 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012265 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12266 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12267 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12268 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12269 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012270 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012271
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012272djb2([<avalanche>])
12273 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12274 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12275 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12276 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12277 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12278 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12279 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012280 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12281 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012282
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012283even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012284 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012285 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12286
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012287field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12288 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12289 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12290 list of chars.
12291
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012292hex
12293 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12294 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12295 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12296 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012297
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012298http_date([<offset>])
12299 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12300 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12301 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12302 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12303 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12304 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012305
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012306in_table(<table>)
12307 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12308 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12309 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12310 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12311 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12312
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012313ipmask(<mask>)
12314 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12315 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12316 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12317 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12318
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012319json([<input-code>])
12320 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12321 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012322 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012323 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12324 of errors:
12325 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12326 bytes, ...)
12327 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12328 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12329
12330 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12331 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12332 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12333 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12334 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12335 are :
12336 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12337 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12338 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12339 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12340 error ;
12341 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12342 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12343
12344 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12345 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12346
12347 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012348 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012349 capture request header user-agent len 150
12350 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012351
12352 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12353 GET / HTTP/1.0
12354 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12355
12356 Output log:
12357 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12358
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012359language(<value>[,<default>])
12360 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12361 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12362 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12363 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12364 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12365 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12366 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12367 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12368 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12369 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12370 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12371 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012372
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012373 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012374
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012375 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12376 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012377
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012378 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12379 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12380 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12381 use_backend spanish if es
12382 use_backend french if fr
12383 use_backend english if en
12384 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012385
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012386lower
12387 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12388 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12389 type. The result is of type string.
12390
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012391ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12392 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12393 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12394 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12395 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12396 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12397 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12398
12399 Example :
12400
12401 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12402 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12403 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12404
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012405map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12406map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12407map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12408 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12409 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12410 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12411 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12412 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12413 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12414 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12415 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012416
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012417 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12418 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12419 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012420
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012421 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012422 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012424 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12425 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12426 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12427 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012428 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12429 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012430 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12431 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12432 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12433 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12434 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12435 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12436 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12437 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012438 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12439 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12440 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012441 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12442 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12443 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12444 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12445 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012446
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012447 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12448 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12449 the corresponding match text.
12450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012451 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12452 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12453 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12454 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12455 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012457 Example :
12458
12459 # this is a comment and is ignored
12460 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12461 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12462 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12463 | | | `---------- value
12464 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12465 | `---------------------------- key
12466 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12467
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012468mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012469 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12470 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012471 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012472 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12475 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12476 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12477 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12478 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012479 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012480
12481mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012482 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012483 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12484 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012485 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012486 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012487 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012488 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12489 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12490 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12491 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12492 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012493 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012494
12495neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012496 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12497 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12498 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12499 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012500
12501not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012502 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012503 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12504 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12505 absence of a flag).
12506
12507odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012508 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012509 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12510
12511or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012512 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012513 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012514 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12515 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012516 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012517 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12518 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12519 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12520 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12521 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012522 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012523
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012524regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012525 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12526 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12527 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12528 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12529 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12530 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12531 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12532 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12533 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12534 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012535 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12536 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12537 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12538 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012539
12540 Example :
12541
12542 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12543 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12544 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12545 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12546
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012547capture-req(<id>)
12548 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12549 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12550
12551 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012552 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12553 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012554
12555capture-res(<id>)
12556 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12557 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12558
12559 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012560 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12561 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012562
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012563sdbm([<avalanche>])
12564 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12565 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12566 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12567 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12568 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12569 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12570 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012571 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12572 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012573
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012574set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012575 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12576 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12577 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012578 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012579 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12580 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012581 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012582 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12583 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012584 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012585 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012586
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012587sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012588 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12589 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012590 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012591 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12592 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012593 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012594 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12595 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012596 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012597 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12598 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012599 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012600 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012601
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012602table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12603 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12604 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12605 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12606 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12607 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12608 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12609
12610
12611table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12612 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12613 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12614 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12615 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12616 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12617 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12618
12619table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12620 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12621 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12622 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12623 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12624 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12625
12626table_conn_cur(<table>)
12627 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12628 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12629 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12630 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12631 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12632
12633table_conn_rate(<table>)
12634 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12635 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12636 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12637 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12638 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12639
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012640table_gpt0(<table>)
12641 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12642 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12643 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12644 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12645 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12646
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012647table_gpc0(<table>)
12648 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12649 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12650 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12651 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12652 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12653
12654table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12655 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12656 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12657 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12658 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12659 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12660 sample fetch keyword.
12661
12662table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12663 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12664 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12665 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12666 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12667 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12668
12669table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12670 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12671 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12672 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12673 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12674 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12675 keyword.
12676
12677table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12678 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12679 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12680 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12681 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12682 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12683
12684table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12687 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12688 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12689 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12690 keyword.
12691
12692table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12693 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12694 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12695 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12696 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12697 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12698 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12699 keyword.
12700
12701table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12702 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12703 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12704 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12705 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12706 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12707 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12708 keyword.
12709
12710table_server_id(<table>)
12711 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12712 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12713 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12714 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12715 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12716 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12717
12718table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12719 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12720 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12721 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12722 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12723 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12724 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12725 keyword.
12726
12727table_sess_rate(<table>)
12728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12731 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12732 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12733 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12734 keyword.
12735
12736table_trackers(<table>)
12737 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12738 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12739 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12740 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12741 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12742 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12743 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12744 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12745 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12746 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12747
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012748upper
12749 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12750 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12751 type. The result is of type string.
12752
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012753url_dec
12754 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12755 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12756
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012757unset-var(<var name>)
12758 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12759 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12760 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12761 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12762 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12763 response),
12764 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12765 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12766 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12767 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12768
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012769utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12770 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12771 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12772 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12773 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12774 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12775 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12776
12777 Example :
12778
12779 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12780 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12781 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12782
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012783word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12784 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12785 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12786
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012787wt6([<avalanche>])
12788 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12789 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12790 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12791 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12792 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12793 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12794 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012795 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12796 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012797
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012798xor(<value>)
12799 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012800 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012801 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012802 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012803 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012804 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12805 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012806 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012807 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12808 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012809 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012810 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012811
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010012812xxh32([<seed>])
12813 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
12814 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12815 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12816 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12817 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12818 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12819 as cryptographically secure.
12820
12821xxh64([<seed>])
12822 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
12823 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12824 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12825 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12826 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12827 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12828 as cryptographically secure.
12829
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012830
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200128317.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832--------------------------------------------
12833
12834A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12835not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12836"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12837The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12838
12839always_false : boolean
12840 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12841 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12842
12843always_true : boolean
12844 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12845 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12846
12847avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012848 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12850 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12851 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12852 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12853 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12854 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12855 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12856 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12857 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12858 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12859 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12860 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12861 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012864 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12865 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12866 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12867 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12868 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12871 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12872 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12873 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12874 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12875 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12876 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012877
12878 Example :
12879 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12880 backend dynamic
12881 mode http
12882 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12883 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012884
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012885bin(<hexa>) : bin
12886 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12887 of the string.
12888
12889bool(<bool>) : bool
12890 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12891 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12894 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012895 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12897 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012898
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012899 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012900 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012901 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12902
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012903 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12904 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012905
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012906 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012907 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012909 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12910 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012911 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012912 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012913
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012914 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12915 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012917 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012918
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012919date([<offset>]) : integer
12920 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12921 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12922 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12923 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012924 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12925
12926 Example :
12927
12928 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12929 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012930
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012931env(<name>) : string
12932 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12933 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12934 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12935 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12936 certain way.
12937
12938 Examples :
12939 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12940 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12941
12942 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12943 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012945fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12946 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012947 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12948 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12950 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12951 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12952 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12953 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012954
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020012955fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12956 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
12957 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
12958 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
12959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012960fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12961 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12962 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12963 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12964 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12965 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12966 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12967 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12968 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012969
12970 Example :
12971 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12972 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12973 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12974 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12975 frontend mail
12976 bind :25
12977 mode tcp
12978 maxconn 100
12979 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12980 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12981 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12982 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012983
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012984int(<integer>) : signed integer
12985 Returns a signed integer.
12986
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012987ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12988 Returns an ipv4.
12989
12990ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12991 Returns an ipv6.
12992
12993meth(<method>) : method
12994 Returns a method.
12995
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012996nbproc : integer
12997 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12998 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12999 and debugging purposes.
13000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13002 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13003 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13004 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013005 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13006 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13007 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013008
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013009proc : integer
13010 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13011 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13012 debugging purposes.
13013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013014queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013015 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13016 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13017 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013018 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13019 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13020 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13021 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13022 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13023
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013024rand([<range>]) : integer
13025 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13026 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13027 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13028 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13029 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013031srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13032 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13033 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13034 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13035 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13036 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13037 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13038 methods.
13039
13040srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13041 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13042 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13043 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13044 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13045 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13046 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13047 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13048
13049srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13050 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13051 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013052 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13054 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13055 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13056 overloading servers).
13057
13058 Example :
13059 # Redirect to a separate back
13060 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13061 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13062 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13063
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013064stopping : boolean
13065 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13066 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13067 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13068
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013069str(<string>) : string
13070 Returns a string.
13071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013072table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13073 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13074 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13075
13076table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13077 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13078 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13079 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13080
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013081var(<var-name>) : undefined
13082 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013083 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13084 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013085 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013086 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13087 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013088 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013089 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13090 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013091 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013092 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013093
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130947.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095----------------------------------
13096
13097The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13098closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13099methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13100sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13101TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013102the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13103counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13104"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013105argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13106the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13107this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108
13109be_id : integer
13110 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13111 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13112
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013113be_name : string
13114 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13115 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117dst : ip
13118 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13119 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13120 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13121 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13122 RFC 4291.
13123
13124dst_conn : integer
13125 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13126 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13127 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13128 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13129 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13130 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13131 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13132 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013133
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013134dst_is_local : boolean
13135 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13136 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13137 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13138 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13139 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13140 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13141 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13142 it only once per connection.
13143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013144dst_port : integer
13145 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13146 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13147 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13148 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13149 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13150 an HTTP header.
13151
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013152fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13153 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13154 header.
13155
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013156fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13157 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13158 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13159 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13160 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13161 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13162 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13163
13164fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13165 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13166 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13167 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13168 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13169 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13170 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13171
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013172fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13173 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13174 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13175 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13176 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13177
13178fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13179 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13180 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13181 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13182 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13183
13184fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13185 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13186 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13187 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13188 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13189
13190fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13191 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13192 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13193 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13194 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13195
13196fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13197 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13198 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13199 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13200 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13201
13202fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13203 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13204 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13205 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13206 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208fe_id : integer
13209 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013210 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13212
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013213fe_name : string
13214 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13215 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13216 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13217
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013218sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013219sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13220sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13221sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013222 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13223 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13224 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13225
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013226sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013227sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13228sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13229sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013230 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13231 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13232 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13233
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013234sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013235sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13236sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13237sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013238 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13239 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013240 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13241 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13242 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013243
13244 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13245 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013246 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13247 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13248 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013249 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13250 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13251
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013252sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013253sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13254sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13255sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013256 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13257 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13258
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013259sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013260sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13261sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13262sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013263 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13264 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13265 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13266
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013267sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013268sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13269sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13270sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013271 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13272 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13273 See also src_conn_rate.
13274
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013275sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013276sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13277sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13278sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013279 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013280 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013281
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013282sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13283sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13284sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13285sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13286 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13287 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13288
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013289sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013290sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13291sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13292sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013293 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13294 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13295 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013296 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13297 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13298 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013299
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013300sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013301sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13302sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13303sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013304 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13305 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13306 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13307
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013308sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013309sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13310sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13311sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013312 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13313 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13314 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13315 src_http_err_rate.
13316
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013317sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013318sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13319sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13320sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013321 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13322 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13323 src_http_req_cnt.
13324
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013325sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013326sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13327sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13328sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013329 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13330 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13331 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13332 src_http_req_rate.
13333
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013334sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013335sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13336sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13337sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013338 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013339 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13340 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13341 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13342 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013343
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013344 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13345 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013346 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13347
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013348sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013349sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13350sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13351sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013352 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13353 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13354 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013355
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013356sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013357sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13358sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13359sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013360 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13361 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13362 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013363
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013364sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013365sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13366sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13367sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013368 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13369 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13370 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13371 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013372 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013373 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13374
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013375sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013376sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13377sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13378sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013379 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13380 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13381 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13382 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13383 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013384 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013386sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013387sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13388sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13389sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013390 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13391 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13392 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013394sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013395sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13396sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13397sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013398 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13399 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013400 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013401 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13402 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013403 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13404 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13405 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013407so_id : integer
13408 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13409 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13410 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013412src : ip
13413 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13414 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13415 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13416 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013417 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13418 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13419 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13420 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013421
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013422 Example:
13423 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13424 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13427 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13428 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13429 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013430 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013432src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13433 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13434 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013435 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013436 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013438src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13439 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13440 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13441 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13442 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13443 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13444 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013445
13446 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13447 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13448 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13449 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013450 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013451 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13452 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013455 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013457 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013458 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013461 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013462 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13463 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013464 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013466src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13467 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13468 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13469 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013470 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013472src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013473 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013474 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013475 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013476 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013477
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013478src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13479 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13480 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13481 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13482 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013484src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013485 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013486 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013487 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13488 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013489 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13490 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13491 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013493src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13494 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13495 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013496 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013497 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013500src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13501 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13502 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13503 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13504 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013505 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013507src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13508 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13509 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13510 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013511 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013513src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13514 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13515 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13516 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013517 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013518 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013520src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13521 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13522 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13523 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013524 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013525 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13526 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013527
13528 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013529 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013530 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013531
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013532src_is_local : boolean
13533 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13534 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13535 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13536 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13537 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13538 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13539 once per connection.
13540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013541src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013542 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13543 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13544 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13545 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13546 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013548src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013549 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13550 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13551 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13552 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13553 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555src_port : integer
13556 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13557 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13558 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13559 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013561src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13562 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013563 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13564 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13565 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013566 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013568src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13569 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13570 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13571 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13572 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013573 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013575src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13576 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13577 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13578 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13579 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13580 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13581 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13582 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13583 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013584
13585 Example :
13586 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13587 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13588 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13589 listen ssh
13590 bind :22
13591 mode tcp
13592 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013593 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013594 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013595 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013597srv_id : integer
13598 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13599 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13600 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013601
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136027.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013603----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013605The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13606closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13607when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13608usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013609future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013610
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001361151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13612 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13613 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13614 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13615 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13616 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13617
13618 Example :
13619 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13620 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13621 # the request.
13622 frontend http-in
13623 bind *:8081
13624 default_backend servers
13625 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13626 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13627
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013628ssl_bc : boolean
13629 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13630 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13631 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13632
13633ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13634 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13635 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13636
13637ssl_bc_cipher : string
13638 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13639 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13640
13641ssl_bc_protocol : string
13642 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13643 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13644
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013645ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013646 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013647 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13648 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013649
13650ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13651 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13652 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13653 if session was reused or not.
13654
13655ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13656 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13657 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013659ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13660 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13661 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13662 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13663 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13664 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13667 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13668 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13669 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13670 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013671
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013672ssl_c_der : binary
13673 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13674 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13675 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677ssl_c_err : integer
13678 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13679 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13680 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13681 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13682 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013684ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13685 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13686 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13687 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13688 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13689 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13690 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13691 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13692 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013694ssl_c_key_alg : string
13695 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13696 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13697 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013699ssl_c_notafter : string
13700 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13701 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13702 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013704ssl_c_notbefore : string
13705 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13706 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13707 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013709ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13710 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13711 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13712 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13713 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13714 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13715 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13716 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13717 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719ssl_c_serial : binary
13720 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13721 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13722 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013724ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13725 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13726 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13727 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013728 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13729 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13730
13731 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013733ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13734 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13735 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13736 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013738ssl_c_used : boolean
13739 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13740 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013742ssl_c_verify : integer
13743 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13744 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13745 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13746 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013748ssl_c_version : integer
13749 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13750 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013751
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013752ssl_f_der : binary
13753 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13754 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13755 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013757ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13758 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13759 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13760 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13761 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013762 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13764 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13765 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767ssl_f_key_alg : string
13768 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13769 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13770 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013772ssl_f_notafter : string
13773 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13774 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13775 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013777ssl_f_notbefore : string
13778 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13779 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13780 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013782ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13783 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13784 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13785 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13786 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13787 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13788 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13789 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13790 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013792ssl_f_serial : binary
13793 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13794 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13795 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013796
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013797ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13798 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13799 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13800 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013802ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13803 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13804 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13805 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013807ssl_f_version : integer
13808 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13809 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13810
13811ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013812 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13813 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13814 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013816 Example :
13817 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13818 listen http-https
13819 bind :80
13820 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13821 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13822
13823ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13824 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13825 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13826
13827ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013828 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013829 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13830 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13831 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13832 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13833 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13834 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13835 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13836 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013838ssl_fc_cipher : string
13839 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13840 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013842ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013843 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13844 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013845 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13846 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13847 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13848 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013850ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13851 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013852 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13853 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13854 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13855 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013856
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013857ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013858 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13859 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013861ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013862 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013863 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13864 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13865 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13866 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13867 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13868 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13869 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013871ssl_fc_protocol : string
13872 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13873 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013874
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013875ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013876 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013877 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13878 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013880ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13881 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13882 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13883 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13884 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013886ssl_fc_sni : string
13887 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13888 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13889 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13890 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13891 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13892
13893 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13894 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13895 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013896 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13897 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013899 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013900 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13901 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13904 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13905 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013906
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013907
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139087.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013909------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013911Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13912sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13913only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13914For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13915be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13916can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13917sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13918for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13919content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013921payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13922 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13923 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13924 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13927 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13928 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13929 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013931req.len : integer
13932req_len : integer (deprecated)
13933 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13934 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13935 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13936 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13937 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13938 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13939 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13940 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013942req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13943 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013944 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13945 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13946 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13947 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013949 ACL alternatives :
13950 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013952req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13953 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13954 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13955 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13956 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013958 ACL alternatives :
13959 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013961 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013963req.proto_http : boolean
13964req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13965 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13966 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13967 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13968 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13969 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13970 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13971 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013973 Example:
13974 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13975 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13976 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013977 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13980rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13981 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13982 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13983 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13984 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13985 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13986 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13987 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13990 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13991 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13992 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13993 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13994 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996 ACL derivatives :
13997 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999 Example :
14000 listen tse-farm
14001 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14002 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14003 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14004 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14005 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14006 persist rdp-cookie
14007 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14008 # This is only useful makes sense if
14009 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14010 stick-table type string size 204800
14011 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14012 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14013 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014015 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14016 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14019rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14020 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14021 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14022 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14023 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025 ACL derivatives :
14026 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014027
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014028req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14029 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14030 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014031 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14032 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14033 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14034 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14035 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14038req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14039 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14040 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14041 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14042 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14043 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14044 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14045 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014047req.ssl_sni : string
14048req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14049 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14050 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14051 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14052 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14053 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14054 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14055 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14056 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14057 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14058 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14059 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14060 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014062 ACL derivatives :
14063 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014065 Examples :
14066 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14067 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14068 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14069 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14070 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014071
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014072req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14073 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14074 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14075 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14076 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14077 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14078 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14079 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14080 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14081 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014083req.ssl_ver : integer
14084req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14085 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14086 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14087 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14088 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14089 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14090 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14091 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14092 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14093 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014095 ACL derivatives :
14096 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014097
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014098res.len : integer
14099 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14100 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14101 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14102 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14103 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14104 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14105 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14106 content inspection.
14107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14109 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014110 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14111 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14112 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14113 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014115res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14116 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14117 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14118 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14119 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014122
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014123res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14124rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14125 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14126 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14127 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14128 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14129 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14130 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14131 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133wait_end : boolean
14134 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14135 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14136 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14137 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14138 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14139 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14140 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14141 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014143 Examples :
14144 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14145 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14146 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14149 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14150 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14151 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14152 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14153 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14154 tcp-request content reject
14155
14156
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141577.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014158--------------------------------------
14159
14160It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14161This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14162data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14163its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14164HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14165content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14166to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14167more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14168response are indexed.
14169
14170base : string
14171 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14172 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14173 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14174 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14175 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14176 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14177 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14178 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14179
14180 ACL derivatives :
14181 base : exact string match
14182 base_beg : prefix match
14183 base_dir : subdir match
14184 base_dom : domain match
14185 base_end : suffix match
14186 base_len : length match
14187 base_reg : regex match
14188 base_sub : substring match
14189
14190base32 : integer
14191 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14192 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14193 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014194 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14195 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14196 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014197
14198base32+src : binary
14199 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14200 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14201 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14202 per-URL counters.
14203
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014204capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14205 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14206 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14207 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14208
14209capture.req.method : string
14210 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14211 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14212 because it's allocated.
14213
14214capture.req.uri : string
14215 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14216 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14217 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14218 allocated.
14219
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014220capture.req.ver : string
14221 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14222 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14223 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14224
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014225capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14226 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14227 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14228 The first entry is an index of 0.
14229 See also: "capture response header"
14230
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014231capture.res.ver : string
14232 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14233 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14234 persistent flag.
14235
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014236req.body : binary
14237 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14238 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14239 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14240 the first chunk is analyzed.
14241
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014242req.body_param([<name>) : string
14243 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14244 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14245 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14246 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14247 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14248 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14249 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14250 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14251 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14252 given.
14253
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014254req.body_len : integer
14255 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14256 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14257 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14258 "option http-buffer-request".
14259
14260req.body_size : integer
14261 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14262 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14263 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14264 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14265 "option http-buffer-request".
14266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014267req.cook([<name>]) : string
14268cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14269 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14270 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14271 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14272 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14273 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14274 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14275 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14276 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14277
14278 ACL derivatives :
14279 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14280 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14281 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14282 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14283 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14284 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14285 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14286 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14289cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14290 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14291 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014293req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14294cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14295 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14296 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14297 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14298 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014300cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14301 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14302 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14303 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14304 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014305 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14307 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14308 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14309 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014311hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14312 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14313 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14314 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14315 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014316 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014318req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14319 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14320 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14321 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14322 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14323 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14324 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14325 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14326 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14329 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14330 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14331 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14332 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14335 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14336 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14337 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14338 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14339 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14340 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14341 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14342 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14343 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14344 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14345 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014347 ACL derivatives :
14348 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14349 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14350 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14351 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14352 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14353 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14354 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14355 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14356
14357req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14358hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14359 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14360 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14361 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14362 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14363 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14364 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14365 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14366 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14367 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14368
14369req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14370hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14371 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14372 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14373 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14374 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14375 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14376 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14377 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14378 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14379
14380req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14381hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14382 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14383 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14384 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14385 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14386 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14387 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14388 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14389
14390http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14391 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14392 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14393 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14394 basic auth is supported.
14395
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014396http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14397 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14398 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14399 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14400 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014401 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14402 basic auth is supported.
14403
14404 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014405 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14406 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14407 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14408 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014409
14410http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014411 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14412 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014413 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14414 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014416method : integer + string
14417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14418 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14419 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14420 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14421 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14422 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14423 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014425 ACL derivatives :
14426 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428 Example :
14429 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14430 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14431 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014433path : string
14434 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14435 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14436 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14437 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14438 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14439 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14440 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014442 ACL derivatives :
14443 path : exact string match
14444 path_beg : prefix match
14445 path_dir : subdir match
14446 path_dom : domain match
14447 path_end : suffix match
14448 path_len : length match
14449 path_reg : regex match
14450 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014451
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014452query : string
14453 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14454 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14455 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14456 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014457 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014458 which stops before the question mark.
14459
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014460req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14461 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14462 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14463 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14464 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466req.ver : string
14467req_ver : string (deprecated)
14468 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14469 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14470 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014472 ACL derivatives :
14473 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014475res.comp : boolean
14476 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14477 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14478 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480res.comp_algo : string
14481 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14482 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14483 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485res.cook([<name>]) : string
14486scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14487 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14488 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14489 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014491 ACL derivatives :
14492 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014494res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14495scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14496 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14497 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14498 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14501scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14502 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14503 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14504 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14507 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14508 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14509 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14510 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14511 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14512 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14513 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14514 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14515 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14518 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14519 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14520 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14521 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14522 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14525shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14526 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14527 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14528 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14529 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14530 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14531 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14532 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14533 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535 ACL derivatives :
14536 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14537 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14538 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14539 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14540 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14541 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14542 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14543 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14544
14545res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14546shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14547 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14548 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14549 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14550 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14551 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014553res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14554shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14555 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14556 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14557 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14558 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14559 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14560 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014561
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014562res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14563 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14564 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14565 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14566 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014568res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14569shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14570 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14571 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14572 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14573 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14574 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14575 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014577res.ver : string
14578resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14579 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14580 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014582 ACL derivatives :
14583 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014585set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14586 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14587 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014588 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14592 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014594status : integer
14595 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14596 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14597 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014598
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014599unique-id : string
14600 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14601 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14602 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14603 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14604 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14605 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014607url : string
14608 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14609 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14610 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14611 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14612 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14613 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14614 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616 ACL derivatives :
14617 url : exact string match
14618 url_beg : prefix match
14619 url_dir : subdir match
14620 url_dom : domain match
14621 url_end : suffix match
14622 url_len : length match
14623 url_reg : regex match
14624 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014626url_ip : ip
14627 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14628 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14629 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14630 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14631 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14632 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14633 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635url_port : integer
14636 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14637 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14638 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14639 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014640
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014641urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14642url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014643 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14644 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014645 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14646 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14647 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14648 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14650 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014651 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14652 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014654 ACL derivatives :
14655 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14656 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14657 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14658 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14659 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14660 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14661 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14662 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014663
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014665 Example :
14666 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14667 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14668 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14669 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014670
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014671urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014672 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14673 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14674 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014675
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014676url32 : integer
14677 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14678 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14679 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14680 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14681 is an unsigned integer.
14682
14683url32+src : binary
14684 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14685 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14686 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14687
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146897.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014690---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014692Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14693every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014694order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014696ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14697---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014698FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014699HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014700HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14701HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014702HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14703HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14704HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14705HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14706LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014707METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014708METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014709METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14710METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14711METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14712METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014713METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014714METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014715RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014716REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014717TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014718WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14719---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014720
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147228. Logging
14723----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014724
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014725One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14726provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14727very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14728provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14729state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014730to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014731headers.
14732
14733In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14734about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14735send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14736
14737 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14738 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14739 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14740 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14741 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014742 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14743 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014744
14745The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14746allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14747as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14748while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14749real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14750delay.
14751
14752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147538.1. Log levels
14754---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014755
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014756TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014757source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014758HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14759in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14760track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14761syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14762about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014763
14764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147658.2. Log formats
14766----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014767
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014768HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014769and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14770slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14771options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014772
14773 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14774 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14775 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14776 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14777 extents.
14778
14779 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14780 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14781 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14782 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14783 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14784
14785 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14786 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14787 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14788 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14789 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14790
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014791 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14792 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14793 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14794 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14795
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014796 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14797
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014798Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14799specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14800field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14801servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14802always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14803identifier.
14804
14805Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14806 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14807 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14808 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14809 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14810
14811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148128.2.1. Default log format
14813-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014814
14815This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14816as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14817format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14818
14819 Example :
14820 listen www
14821 mode http
14822 log global
14823 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14824
14825 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14826 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14827 (www/HTTP)
14828
14829 Field Format Extract from the example above
14830 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14831 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14832 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14833 4 'to' to
14834 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14835 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14836
14837Detailed fields description :
14838 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14839 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14840 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14841 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14842 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14843 and processed the connection.
14844 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14845
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014846In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14847"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14848connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14849
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014850It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14851will eventually disappear.
14852
14853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148548.2.2. TCP log format
14855---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014856
14857The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14858is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14859information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14860counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14861emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14862environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14863the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14864sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014865specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14866not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14867fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14868marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014869
14870 Example :
14871 frontend fnt
14872 mode tcp
14873 option tcplog
14874 log global
14875 default_backend bck
14876
14877 backend bck
14878 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14879
14880 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14881 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14882 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14883
14884 Field Format Extract from the example above
14885 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14886 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14887 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14888 4 frontend_name fnt
14889 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14890 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14891 7 bytes_read* 212
14892 8 termination_state --
14893 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14894 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14895
14896Detailed fields description :
14897 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014898 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14899 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14900 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014901 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14902 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14903 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014904
14905 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014906 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14907 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14908 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014909
14910 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14911 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14912 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14913 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14914
14915 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14916 and processed the connection.
14917
14918 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14919 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14920 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14921 applications.
14922
14923 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14924 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14925 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14926 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14927 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14928
14929 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14930 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14931 See "Timers" below for more details.
14932
14933 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14934 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14935 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14936 "Timers" below for more details.
14937
14938 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014939 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014940 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14941 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14942 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14943 details.
14944
14945 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14946 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14947 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14948 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14949 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14950
14951 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14952 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14953 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14954 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14955 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14956 for more details.
14957
14958 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014959 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014960 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14961 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14962 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014963 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014964
14965 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14966 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14967 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14968 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14969 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14970 caused by a denial of service attack.
14971
14972 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14973 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14974 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14975 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14976 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14977 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14978 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14979 denial of service attack.
14980
14981 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14982 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14983 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14984 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14985 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14986 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14987 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14988 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14989 be processed than on other servers.
14990
14991 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14992 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14993 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14994 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14995 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14996 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14997 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14998 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14999 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15000 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15001 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15002 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15003 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15004
15005 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15006 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15007 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15008 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15009 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15010 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15011 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15012 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15013
15014 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15015 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15016 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15017 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15018 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15019 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15020 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15021 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15022 occurs.
15023
15024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150258.2.3. HTTP log format
15026----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015027
15028The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15029is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15030the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15031are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15032emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15033generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15034"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15035which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015036frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15037is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015038
15039Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15040slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15041with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15042
15043 Example :
15044 frontend http-in
15045 mode http
15046 option httplog
15047 log global
15048 default_backend bck
15049
15050 backend static
15051 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15052
15053 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15054 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15055 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015056 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015057
15058 Field Format Extract from the example above
15059 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15060 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015061 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015062 4 frontend_name http-in
15063 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015064 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015065 7 status_code 200
15066 8 bytes_read* 2750
15067 9 captured_request_cookie -
15068 10 captured_response_cookie -
15069 11 termination_state ----
15070 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15071 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15072 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15073 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15074 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015075
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015076Detailed fields description :
15077 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015078 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15079 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15080 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015081 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15082 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15083 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015084
15085 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015086 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15087 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15088 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015089
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015090 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15091 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015092
15093 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15094 and processed the connection.
15095
15096 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15097 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15098 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15099
15100 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15101 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15102 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15103 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15104 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15105 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15106
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015107 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15108 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15109 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15110 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15111 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15112 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15113 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015114
15115 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15116 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15117 See "Timers" below for more details.
15118
15119 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15120 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15121 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15122 below for more details.
15123
15124 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15125 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15126 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15127 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15128 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15129 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15130 for more details.
15131
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015132 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15133 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15134 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15135 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15136 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15137 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15138 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15139 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015140
15141 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15142 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15143 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15144
15145 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15146 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15147 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15148 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15149 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15150 overflowing.
15151
15152 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15153 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15154 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15155 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15156 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15157 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15158 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15159 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15160
15161 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15162 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15163 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15164 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15165 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15166 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15167 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15168 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15169
15170 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15171 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15172 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15173 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15174 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15175 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15176 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15177
15178 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015179 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015180 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15181 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15182 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015183 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015184 system.
15185
15186 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15187 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15188 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15189 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15190 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15191 caused by a denial of service attack.
15192
15193 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15194 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15195 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15196 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15197 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15198 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15199 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15200 denial of service attack.
15201
15202 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15203 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15204 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15205 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15206 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15207 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15208 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15209 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15210 processed than on other servers.
15211
15212 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15213 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15214 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15215 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15216 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15217 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15218 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15219 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15220 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15221 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15222 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15223 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15224 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15225
15226 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15227 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15228 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15229 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15230 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15231 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15232 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15233 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15234
15235 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15236 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15237 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15238 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15239 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15240 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15241 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15242 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15243 occurs.
15244
15245 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15246 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15247 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15248 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15249 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15250 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15251 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15252 cookies" below for more details.
15253
15254 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15255 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15256 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15257 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15258 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15259 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15260 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15261 and cookies" below for more details.
15262
15263 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15264 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15265 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15266 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15267 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15268 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15269 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15270 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15271
15272
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200152738.2.4. Custom log format
15274------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015275
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015276The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015277mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015278
15279HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15280Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15281separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15282prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15283
15284Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15285variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015286("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015287
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015288If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015289as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015290less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15291the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15292
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015293Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015294In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015295in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015296
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015297Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15298'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15299https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15300such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15301
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015302Flags are :
15303 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015304 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015305 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15306 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015307
15308 Example:
15309
15310 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15311 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15312
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015313 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15314
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015315At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15316
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015317 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15318 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015319
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015320the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015321
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015322 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15323 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15324 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015325
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015326and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15327
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015328 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15329 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015330
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015331Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15332
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015333 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015334 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015335 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15336 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15337 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015338 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15339 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15340 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015341 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015342 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15343 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015344 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015345 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15346 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015347 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015348 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015349 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015350 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015351 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015352 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015353 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015354 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15355 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15356 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15357 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15358 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015359 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015360 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15361 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015362 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015363 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15364 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015365 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15366 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15367 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015368 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015369 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15370 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015371 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015372 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15373 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15374 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015375 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015376 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015377 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15378 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15379 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15380 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015381 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015382 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015383 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015384 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015385 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015386 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015387 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15388 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15389 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015390 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015391 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15392 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015393 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015394 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15395 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15396 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015397 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015398 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015399 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015400
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015401 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015402
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015403
154048.2.5. Error log format
15405-----------------------
15406
15407When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15408protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15409By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15410"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15411will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15412logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15413
15414The format looks like this :
15415
15416 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15417 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15418 Connection error during SSL handshake
15419
15420 Field Format Extract from the example above
15421 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15422 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15423 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15424 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15425 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15426
15427These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15428failures.
15429
15430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154318.3. Advanced logging options
15432-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015433
15434Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15435just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15436options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15437for more information about their usage.
15438
15439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154408.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15441------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015442
15443It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15444haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15445commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15446monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15447ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15448
15449 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15450 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15451 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15452 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15453
15454 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15455 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15456 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015457 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015458 such as other load-balancers.
15459
15460 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15461 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15462 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15463
15464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154658.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15466----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015467
15468The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15469what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15470or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15471"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15472just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15473log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15474after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15475is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15476with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15477with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15478
15479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154808.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15481------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015482
15483Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15484for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15485"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15486retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15487raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15488a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15489file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15490you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15491"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15492
15493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154948.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15495--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015496
15497Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15498multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15499them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15500"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15501logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15502error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15503and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15504too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15505useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15506alternative.
15507
15508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155098.4. Timing events
15510------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015511
15512Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15513reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15514the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15515frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015516mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15517addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15518
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015519Timings events in HTTP mode:
15520
15521 first request 2nd request
15522 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15523 t tr t tr ...
15524 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15525 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15526 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15527 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15528 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15529
15530Timings events in TCP mode:
15531
15532 TCP session
15533 |<----------------->|
15534 t t
15535 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15536 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15537 |<------ Tt ------->|
15538
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015539 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15540 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15541 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15542 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15543 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15544 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15545 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015546
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015547 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15548 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15549 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15550 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15551 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15552 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15553 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15554 nothing was received on the connection.
15555
15556 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15557 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15558 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15559 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15560 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15561 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15562 request typed by hand during a test.
15563
15564 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15565 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15566 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15567 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15568 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15569 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15570 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015571
15572 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15573 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15574 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15575 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15576 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15577
15578 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15579 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15580 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15581 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15582 connection never established.
15583
15584 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15585 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15586 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15587 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15588 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15589 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15590 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15591 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15592 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15593 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15594 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15595
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015596 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15597 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15598 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15599 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15600 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15601 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15602
15603 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15604
15605 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15606 "Ta" can never be negative.
15607
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015608 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15609 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015610 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15611 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015612 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015613
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015614 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015615
15616 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015617 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15618 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015619
15620These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15621protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15622that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015623due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15624"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15625that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015626
15627Most common cases :
15628
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015629 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15630 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15631 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15632 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15633 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15634 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15635 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15636 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15637 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15638 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15639 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015640 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015641
15642 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15643 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15644 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15645 of ms on remote networks.
15646
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015647 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15648 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15649 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015650
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015651 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15652 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15653 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15654 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15655 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15656 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15657 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15658 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15659 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015660
15661Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15662
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015663 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015664 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015665 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015666
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015667 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015668 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15669 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15670
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015671 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015672 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15673 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15674 flags.
15675
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015676 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15677 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015678 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15679 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15680 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15681 the client connection was maintained open.
15682
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015683 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015684 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015685 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015686 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15687
15688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156898.5. Session state at disconnection
15690-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015691
15692TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15693"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
156942-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15695each of which has a special meaning :
15696
15697 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15698 session to terminate :
15699
15700 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15701
15702 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15703 server explicitly refused it.
15704
15705 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15706 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15707 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15708 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015709 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15710
15711 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15712 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015713
15714 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15715 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15716 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15717 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15718 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15719
15720 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15721 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15722 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15723 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15724 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15725
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015726 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15727 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15728
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015729 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15730 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15731 backup connections when going up.
15732
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015733 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15734
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015735 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15736 send or receive data.
15737
15738 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15739 send or receive data.
15740
15741 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15742 with nothing left in the buffers.
15743
15744 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15745
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015746 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015747 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15748
15749 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15750 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15751 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15752 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15753 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15754
15755 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15756 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15757
15758 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15759 server (HTTP only).
15760
15761 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15762
15763 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15764 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15765 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15766
15767 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15768 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15769 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15770
15771 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15772
15773 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15774 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15775
15776 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15777 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15778 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15779
15780 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15781 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015782 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15783 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015784
15785 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15786 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15787 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15788 another server.
15789
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015790 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015791 server.
15792
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015793 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15794 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15795 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15796 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15797
15798 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15799 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15800 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15801 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15802
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015803 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15804 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15805 "use-server" rule).
15806
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015807 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15808
15809 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15810 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15811
15812 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15813
15814 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15815 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15816 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15817
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015818 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15819 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015820 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015821 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15822 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15823
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015824 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15825
15826 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15827 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15828
15829 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15830
15831 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15832
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015833The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15834was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015835helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15836starvation, attacks, etc...
15837
15838The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15839alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15840easier finding and understanding.
15841
15842 Flags Reason
15843
15844 -- Normal termination.
15845
15846 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15847 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15848 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15849 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15850
15851 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15852 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15853 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15854 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15855 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15856 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015857
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015858 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15859 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015860 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015861
15862 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15863 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15864 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15865
15866 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15867 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15868 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15869 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15870 the server takes too long to respond.
15871
15872 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15873 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15874 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15875 long a time to respond.
15876
15877 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15878 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15879 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15880 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015881 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15882 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015883
15884 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15885 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15886 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15887 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15888 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015889 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015890 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15891 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15892 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15893 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15894 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15895 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15896 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15897 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15898 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15899 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15900 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15901 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015902
15903 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15904 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015905 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15906 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15907 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15908 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015909
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015910 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15911 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015913 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015914 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15915 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15916 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15917 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15918 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15919
15920 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15921 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15922 503 or 504 here.
15923
15924 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15925 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15926 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15927 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15928 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15929
15930 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15931 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015932 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015933 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15934 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15935
15936 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15937 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15938 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15939 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15940 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15941 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15942 between haproxy and the server.
15943
15944 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15945 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15946 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15947 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15948 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15949 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15950 solution is to fix the application.
15951
15952 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15953 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15954 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15955 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15956 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15957 external attacks.
15958
15959 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15960 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015961 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015962 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15963 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15964
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015965 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15966 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15967 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015968 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15969 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015970
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015971 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15972 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15973 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15974 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015975 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15976 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15977 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15978 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15979 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015980
15981 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15982 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15983 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15984 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15985
15986 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15987 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15988 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15989 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15990
15991 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15992 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15993 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15994 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15995
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015996The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15997persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15998important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15999re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16000
16001 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16002
16003 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16004 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16005 set on a GET request.
16006
16007 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16008 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016009 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016010 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16011
16012 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16013 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16014 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16015
16016 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16017 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16018 already got a cookie.
16019
16020 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16021 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16022 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16023 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16024 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16025
16026 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16027 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16028 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16029
16030 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16031 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16032 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16033
16034 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16035 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16036
16037 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16038 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16039 then advertised in the response.
16040
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160428.6. Non-printable characters
16043-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016044
16045In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16046consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16047converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16048prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16049being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16050escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16051is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16052'}' when logging headers.
16053
16054Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16055issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16056containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16057
16058Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16059the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16060performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16061
16062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160638.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16064---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016065
16066Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16067achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016068section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016069cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16070the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16071the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016072locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016073not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16074user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16075a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16076wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16077
16078 Examples :
16079 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16080 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16081
16082 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16083 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16084
16085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160868.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16087---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016088
16089Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16090proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16091the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16092server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16093
16094Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16095response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016096section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016097
16098It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016099time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16100appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016101are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16102and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16103follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16104request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16105in the logs.
16106
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016107As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16108frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16109an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16110
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016111 Example :
16112 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16113 listen proxy-out
16114 mode http
16115 option httplog
16116 option logasap
16117 log global
16118 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16119
16120 # log the name of the virtual server
16121 capture request header Host len 20
16122
16123 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16124 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16125
16126 # log the beginning of the referrer
16127 capture request header Referer len 20
16128
16129 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16130 capture response header Server len 20
16131
16132 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16133 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16134
16135 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16136 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16137
16138 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16139 capture response header Via len 20
16140
16141 # log the URL location during a redirection
16142 capture response header Location len 20
16143
16144 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16145 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16146 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16147 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16148 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16149
16150 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16151 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16152 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16153 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016154 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016155
16156 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16157 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16158 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16159 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16160 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016161 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016162
16163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161648.9. Examples of logs
16165---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016166
16167These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16168them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16169reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16170
16171 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16172 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16173 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16174
16175 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16176 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16177
16178 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16179 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16180 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16181
16182 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16183 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16184
16185 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16186 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16187 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16188
16189 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016190 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016191 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16192 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16193
16194 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16195 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16196 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16197
16198 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16199 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016200 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016201 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16202 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16203 to return the 502 and not the server.
16204
16205 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016206 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016207
16208 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16209 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16210 Nothing was sent to any server.
16211
16212 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16213 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16214
16215 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16216 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16217 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16218 send a 408 return code to the client.
16219
16220 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16221 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16222
16223 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16224 5 seconds ("c----").
16225
16226 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16227 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016228 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016229
16230 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016231 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016232 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16233 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16234 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16235 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16236 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016237
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016238
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200162399. Supported filters
16240--------------------
16241
16242Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16243accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16244unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16245
16246See also : "filter"
16247
162489.1. Trace
16249----------
16250
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016251filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016252
16253 Arguments:
16254 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16255 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16256
16257 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16258 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16259 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16260 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16261
16262 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16263 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16264 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16265 amount of the parsed data.
16266
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016267 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16268
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016269This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16270callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16271information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16272filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16273
16274Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16275tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16276a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16277
16278
162799.2. HTTP compression
16280---------------------
16281
16282filter compression
16283
16284The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16285keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16286when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16287use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16288used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16289filters evaluation order.
16290
16291See also : "compression"
16292
16293
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200162949.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16295--------------------------------------------
16296
16297filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16298
16299 Arguments :
16300
16301 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16302 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16303 parsed.
16304
16305 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16306 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16307 part must be placed in its own scope.
16308
16309The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16310external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16311streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16312exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16313also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16314
16315SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16316the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16317
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016318For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016319"doc/SPOE.txt".
16320
16321Important note:
16322 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16323 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016325/*
16326 * Local variables:
16327 * fill-column: 79
16328 * End:
16329 */